706061
134
Zoom out
Zoom in
Previous page
1/139
Next page
Benutzerhandbuch
32HFL5014
43HFL5014
43HFL6014U
50HFL5014
50HFL6014U
55HFL6014U
65HFL6014U
Inhalt
1 TV-Tour 3
1.1 Profimodus 3
2 Konfigurieren 4
2.1 Lesen der Sicherheitshinweise 4
2.2 Standfuß und Wandmontage 4
2.3 Tipps zum Aufstellen 4
2.4 Netzkabel 4
2.5 Antennenkabel 5
3 Fernbedienung 6
3.1 Die Tasten im Überblick 6
3.2 IR-Sensor 7
3.3 Batterien 7
3.4 Pflege 7
4 Ein- und Ausschalten 8
4.1 Einschalten oder Standby 8
4.2 Tasten am Fernseher 8
5 Technische Daten 9
5.1 Umweltschutz 9
5.2 Leistung 10
5.3 Betriebssystem 10
5.4 Empfang 10
5.5 Bildschirmtyp (6014U) 10
5.6 Bildschirmtyp (5014) 10
5.7 Bildschirmauflösung (Eingang) (6014U) 10
5.8 Bildschirmauflösung (Eingang) (5014) 10
5.9 Konnektivität (6014U) 11
5.10 Konnektivität (5014) 11
5.11 Abmessungen und Gewichte 11
5.12 Ton 12
6 Anschließen von Geräten 13
6.1 Anschließen von Geräten 13
6.2 CAM mit Smart Card – CI+ 15
6.3 Receiver – Set-Top-Box 15
6.4 Home Entertainment-System – HES 16
6.5 Smartphones und Tablets 16
6.6 Blu-ray Disc-Player 17
6.7 Kopfhörer 17
6.8 Spielekonsole 17
6.9 USB-Flashlaufwerk 17
6.10 Computer 17
7 Videos, Fotos und Musik 19
7.1 Über eine USB-Verbindung 19
7.2 Wiedergeben Ihrer Videos 19
7.3 Anzeigen Ihrer Fotos 19
7.4 Wiedergeben Ihrer Musik 20
8 TV-Guide 22
8.1 Verwenden des TV-Guide 22
9 Spiele 23
9.1 Spielen 23
10 Professional-Menü-App 24
10.1 Info zur Professional-Menü-App 24
10.2 Professional-Menü-App öffnen 24
10.3 Empfohlen 24
10.4 Fernsehsender 24
10.5 Fernsehsender 25
10.6 Google Cast 26
10.7 Spiele 26
10.8 Mehr 26
10.9 Professional Settings 27
10.10 Google-Konto 28
11 Android TV-Home-Bildschirm 29
11.1 Informationen zum Android TV-Home-Bildschirm
29
11.2 Öffnen des Android TV-Home-Bildschirms 29
11.3 Android-TV-Einstellungen 29
11.4 Anschließen Ihres Android TV 33
11.5 Programme 35
11.6 Einstellung der Sender 37
11.7 Internet 39
11.8 Smartphones und Tablets 39
11.9 Software 39
12 Open-Source-Software 41
12.1 Open-Source-Lizenz 41
13 Hilfe und Support 129
13.1 Fehlerbehebung 129
13.2 Online-Hilfe 131
13.3 Support und Reparatur 131
14 Sicherheit und Sorgfalt 132
14.1 Sicherheit 132
14.2 Bildschirmpflege 133
14.3 Radiation Exposure Statement 133
15 Nutzungsbedingungen 134
15.1 Nutzungsbedingungen – Fernseher 134
16 Copyright 135
16.1 MHL 135
16.2 HDMI 135
16.3 Dolby Audio 135
16.4 DTS-HD Premium Sound™ 135
16.5 WiFi Alliance 135
16.6 Kensington 135
16.7 Andere Marken 135
17 Haftungsausschluss bezüglich Diensten
und Software von Drittanbietern 137
Index 138
2
1
TV-Tour
1.1
Profimodus
Anwendungsmöglichkeiten
Im Profimodus EIN haben Sie Zugriff auf eine Vielzahl
von Experteneinstellungen, die eine erweiterte
Steuerung des Zustands des Fernsehers ermöglichen
oder zusätzliche Funktionen bieten.
Dieser Modus ist für die Installation von Fernsehern
an Orten wie Hotels, Kreuzfahrtschiffen, Stadien oder
anderen kommerziellen Bereichen vorgesehen, an
denen eine solche Steuerung erforderlich ist.
Wenn Sie den Fernseher zu Hause verwenden, wird
empfohlen, ihn im Profimodus AUS zu verwenden.
Weitere Informationen finden Sie im Professional
Installationshandbuch.
3
2
Konfigurieren
2.1
Lesen der
Sicherheitshinweise
Lesen Sie die Sicherheitshinweise, bevor Sie den
Fernseher zum ersten Mal verwenden.
2.2
Standfuß und Wandmontage
Standfuß
Die Montageanweisungen für den Standfuß finden
Sie in der mitgelieferten Kurzanleitung. Falls diese
Anleitung abhanden gekommen ist, können Sie sie
unter www.philips.com herunterladen.
Geben Sie zum Herunterladen des Guide die
Typennummer des Fernsehers in das Suchfeld ein.
Wandmontage
Ihr Gerät kann mit einer VESA-kompatiblen
Wandhalterung verwendet werden (separat
erhältlich).
Nutzen Sie den folgenden VESA-Code, um die
Wandhalterung zu erwerben. . .
• 43HFL6014U
VESA MIS-F 200x200, M6 (min.: 10 mm, max.:
15 mm)
• 50HFL6014U
VESA MIS-F 200x200, M6 (min.: 10 mm, max.:
15 mm)
• 55HFL6014U
VESA MIS-F 300x200, M6 (min.: 11 mm, max.: 14
mm)
• 65HFL6014U
VESA MIS-F 400x200, M6 (min.: 11 mm, max.: 14
mm)
• 32HFL5014
VESA MIS-F 100, M6 (min.: 12 mm, max.: 15 mm)
• 43HFL5014
VESA MIS-F 200x200, M6 (min.: 12 mm, max.:
15 mm)
• 50HFL5014
VESA MIS-F 200x200, M6 (min.: 10 mm, max.:
16 mm)
Vorbereitung
Entfernen Sie zunächst die vier Kunststoff-
Schraubkappen von den Gewindebuchsen auf der
Rückseite des Fernsehers ((Für 5014 43" und 6014U).
Stellen Sie sicher, dass die Metallschrauben zum
Montieren des Fernsehers an der VESA-kompatiblen
Halterung etwa 10 mm in die Gewindebuchsen des
Fernsehers eingedreht werden können.
Vorsicht
Die Wandmontage des Fernsehers erfordert
Fachkenntnisse und sollte nur von qualifiziertem
Personal durchgeführt werden. Bei der Wandmontage
des Fernsehers sollten die dem Gewicht des Geräts
entsprechenden Sicherheitsstandards beachtet
werden. Lesen Sie zudem die Sicherheitshinweise,
bevor Sie den Fernseher aufstellen.
TP Vision Europe B.V. übernimmt keine Haftung für
eine unsachgemäße Montage oder aus der Montage
resultierende Unfälle oder Verletzungen.
2.3
Tipps zum Aufstellen
• Stellen Sie den Fernseher so auf, dass kein direktes
Licht auf den Bildschirm fällt.
• Der ideale Abstand zum Fernseher beträgt das
Dreifache der Bildschirmdiagonale. Im Sitzen sollten
Ihre Augen auf derselben Höhe sein wie die Mitte des
Bildschirms.
• Platzieren Sie den Fernseher bei einer
Wandmontage bis zu 15 cm von der Wand entfernt.
Hinweis:
Halten Sie den Fernseher von stauberzeugenden
Quellen wie Öfen fern. Wir empfehlen, Staub
regelmäßig zu entfernen, um zu vermeiden, dass
dieser in den Fernseher eindringt.
4
2.4
Netzkabel
• Schließen Sie das Netzkabel an den Anschluss
POWER auf der Rückseite des Fernsehers an.
• Stellen Sie sicher, dass das Netzkabel fest in den
Anschluss gesteckt ist.
• Achten Sie darauf, dass der Netzstecker in der
Steckdose jederzeit zugänglich ist.
• Um das Stromkabel vom Netzanschluss zu trennen,
ziehen Sie niemals am Kabel, sondern immer am
Stecker.
2.5
Antennenkabel
Stecken Sie den Antennenstecker fest in die
Antennenbuchse auf der Rückseite des Fernsehers.
Sie können Ihre eigene Antenne anschließen oder
eine Verbindung zu einem Antennensignal von einem
Antennenverteilersystem herstellen. Verwenden Sie
ein HF-Koaxialkabel (75 Ohm) mit IEC-Stecker.
Verwenden Sie diese Antennenverbindung für DVB-
T- und DVB-C-Eingangssignale.
5
3
Fernbedienung
3.1
Die Tasten im Überblick
Oben
1 - Standby-Taste/Ein-/Ausschalter
Einschalten des Fernsehers oder Umschalten in den
Standby-Modus.
2 - YouTube
Zum Öffnen von YouTube.
3 - Alarm (nur im Profimodus EIN)
Zum Einstellen des Alarms.
4 - Google Cast (nur im Profimodus EIN)
Um die Inhalte des Displays Ihres Mobilgeräts auf
dem Fernseher anzuzeigen.
5 - Wetter (nur im Profimodus EIN)
Um die Wetterinformationen für Ihren Standort
anzuzeigen.
6 - SMART-INFO (nur im Profimodus EIN)
Zum Anzeigen von Informationen des Hotels.
Mitte
1 -
SETTINGS
Zum Öffnen des Einstellungsmenüs.
2 -
TV-GUIDE
Zum Öffnen einer Liste aller aktuellen und geplanten
Sendungen Ihrer Sender.
3 - BACK
Zum Umschalten zum zuletzt ausgewählten Sender.
• Zurück zum vorherigen Menü.
4 - OPTIONS
Zum Öffnen bzw. Schließen des Optionsmenüs.
5 - OK
-Taste
Zum Bestätigen einer Auswahl oder Einstellung.
6 - Pfeil-
/Navigationstasten
Zum Navigieren nach oben , unten , links oder
rechts .
7 -
Sender
Zum Wechseln zum vorherigen oder nächsten Sender
in der Senderliste.
8 - EXIT
Zum Umschalten zur Wiedergabe des
Fernsehprogramms.
9
- HOME
Zum Öffnen des Home-Menüs.
Unten
6
1
- Lautstärke
Zum Einstellen der Lautstärke.
2 - Farbtasten
Direktwahl von Optionen.
3 - CLOCK
Zum Anzeigen der Uhr.
4 - Sender
Zum Wechseln zum vorherigen oder nächsten Sender
in der Senderliste.
5 - Stummschalten
Zum Aus-/Einschalten des Tons.
3.2
IR-Sensor
Der Fernseher kann Befehle von einer Fernbedienung
empfangen, die Infrarot (IR) zur Befehlsübertragung
verwendet. Achten Sie bei der Verwendung einer
derartigen Fernbedienung darauf, dass die
Fernbedienung stets auf den Infrarotsensor an der
Vorderseite des Fernsehers gerichtet ist.
Warnung
Stellen Sie nichts vor den Infrarotsensor des
Fernsehers. Objekte könnten das IR-Signal
blockieren.
3.3
Batterien
Wenn der Fernseher nicht auf einen Tastendruck auf
der Fernbedienung reagiert, sind möglicherweise die
Batterien leer.
Um die Batterien auszutauschen, öffnen Sie das
Batteriefach an der Tastaturseite der Fernbedienung.
1 - Schieben Sie die Batterieabdeckung in die durch
den Pfeil angegebene Richtung.
2 - Ersetzen Sie die alten Batterien durch zwei
Batterien des Typs AAA-R03-1,5 V . Vergewissern Sie
sich, dass die Polungen + und - der Batterien richtig
ausgerichtet sind.
3 - Setzen Sie die Batterieabdeckung wieder auf, und
schieben Sie sie zurück, bis sie hörbar einrastet.
• Entnehmen Sie die Batterien, wenn Sie die
Fernbedienung über einen längeren Zeitraum nicht
verwenden.
• Entsorgen Sie alte Batterien sicher entsprechend der
für das Nutzungsende geltenden Anweisungen.
3.4
Pflege
Die Fernbedienung wurde mit einer kratzfesten
Beschichtung behandelt.
Reinigen Sie die Fernbedienung mit einem weichen,
feuchten Tuch. Verwenden Sie dabei keine
Substanzen wie Alkohol, Chemikalien oder
Haushaltsreiniger.
7
4
Ein- und
Ausschalten
4.1
Einschalten oder Standby
Vergewissern Sie sich, dass der Fernseher an die
Stromversorgung angeschlossen ist. Schließen Sie das
im Lieferumfang enthaltene Netzkabel an den AC-
Eingang auf der Rückseite des Fernsehers an. Die
Anzeige am unteren Rand des Fernsehers leuchtet
auf.
Einschalten
Drücken Sie auf der Fernbedienung die Taste , um
den Fernseher einzuschalten. Alternativ können Sie
auch die Taste Home drücken. Sie können auch
die kleine Joystick-Taste auf der Rückseite des
Fernsehers drücken, um den Fernseher einzuschalten,
wenn Sie die Fernbedienung nicht finden können
oder die Batterien leer sind.
Umschalten in den Standby-Modus
Drücken Sie zum Umschalten in den Standby-
Modus auf der Fernbedienung. Sie können dazu
auch die kleine Joystick-Taste auf der Rückseite des
Fernsehers drücken.
Im Standby-Modus ist der Fernseher weiterhin an die
Stromversorgung angeschlossen, verbraucht jedoch
nur sehr wenig Energie.
Um den Fernseher vollständig auszuschalten, ziehen
Sie den Netzstecker heraus.
Ziehen Sie dazu niemals am Kabel, sondern immer
am Stecker. Stellen Sie sicher, dass der Zugang zum
Netzstecker, Netzkabel und zur Steckdose jederzeit
frei ist.
4.2
Tasten am Fernseher
Wenn Sie Ihre Fernbedienung verloren haben oder
die Batterien leer sind, können Sie dennoch einige
grundlegende Funktionen des Fernsehers nutzen.
So öffnen Sie das Basismenü:
1 - Drücken Sie bei eingeschaltetem Fernseher die
Joystick-Taste auf der Rückseite des Fernsehers, um
das Basismenü aufzurufen.
2 - Drücken Sie nach links oder rechts, um
Lautstärke, Sender oder Quellen
auszuwählen. Wählen Sie Demo, um einen Demo-
Film zu starten.
3 - Drücken Sie nach oben oder unten, um die
Lautstärke einzustellen oder zum nächsten oder
vorangehenden Sender zu schalten. Wenn Sie nach
oben oder unten drücken, können Sie durch die Liste
der Quellen navigieren, darunter die Tuner-Auswahl.
Drücken Sie die Joystick-Taste, um den Demo-Film
zu starten.
4 - Das Menü wird automatisch ausgeblendet.
Um den Fernseher aus dem Standby-Modus
einzuschalten, wählen Sie aus, und drücken Sie die
Joystick-Taste.
8
5
Technische Daten
5.1
Umweltschutz
Europäisches Energie-Label
Das Europäische Energie-Label informiert Sie über
die Energieeffizienzklasse des Produkts. Je grüner die
Energieeffizienzklasse des Produkts ist, desto weniger
Energie verbraucht es.
Auf dem Label werden die Energieeffizienzklasse, der
durchschnittliche Stromverbrauch des Produkts bei
Gebrauch und der durchschnittliche Energieverbrauch
pro Jahr angegeben. Die Werte für den
Stromverbrauch finden Sie ebenfalls auf der Philips
Website für Ihr Land unter www.philips.com/TV.
Produktdatenblatt
43HFL6014U
• Energieeffizienzklasse: A
• Größe des sichtbaren Bildschirms: 108 cm (43")
• Energieverbrauch im eingeschalteten Zustand (W):
67 W
• Jährlicher Energieverbrauch (kWh)*: 98 kWh
• Energieverbrauch Standby (W)**: 0,3 W
• Bildschirmauflösung (Pixel): 3840 x 2160p
50HFL6014U
• Energieeffizienzklasse: A+
• Größe des sichtbaren Bildschirms: 126 cm (50")
• Energieverbrauch im eingeschalteten Zustand (W):
70 W
• Jährlicher Energieverbrauch (kWh)*: 103 kWh
• Energieverbrauch Standby (W)**: 0,3 W
• Bildschirmauflösung (Pixel): 3840 x 2160p
55HFL6014U
• Energieeffizienzklasse: A+
• Größe des sichtbaren Bildschirms: 139 cm (55")
• Energieverbrauch im eingeschalteten Zustand
(W): 84 W
• Jährlicher Energieverbrauch (kWh)*: 123 kWh
• Energieverbrauch Standby (W)**: 0,3 W
• Bildschirmauflösung (Pixel): 3840 x 2160p
65HFL6014U
• Energieeffizienzklasse: A+
• Größe des sichtbaren Bildschirms: 164 cm (65")
• Energieverbrauch im eingeschalteten Zustand
(W): 105 W
• Jährlicher Energieverbrauch (kWh)*: 154 kWh
• Energieverbrauch Standby (W)**: 0,3 W
• Bildschirmauflösung (Pixel): 3840 x 2160p
32HFL5014
• Energieeffizienzklasse: A+
• Größe des sichtbaren Bildschirms: 80 cm (32")
• Energieverbrauch im eingeschalteten Zustand (W):
29 W
• Jährlicher Energieverbrauch (kWh)*: 43 kWh
• Energieverbrauch Standby (W)**: 0,35 W
• Bildschirmauflösung (Pixel): 1.920 x 1.080
43HFL5014
• Energieeffizienzklasse: A+
• Größe des sichtbaren Bildschirms: 108 cm (43")
• Energieverbrauch im eingeschalteten Zustand (W):
48 W
• Jährlicher Energieverbrauch (kWh)*: 71 kWh
• Energieverbrauch Standby (W)**: 0,3 W
• Bildschirmauflösung (Pixel): 1.920 x 1.080
50HFL5014
• Energieeffizienzklasse: A++
• Größe des sichtbaren Bildschirms: 126 cm (50")
• Energieverbrauch im eingeschalteten Zustand (W):
49 W
• Jährlicher Energieverbrauch (kWh)*: 72 kWh
• Energieverbrauch Standby (W)**: 0,3 W
• Bildschirmauflösung (Pixel): 1.920 x 1.080
* Energieverbrauch in kWh/Jahr, basierend auf einem
Betrieb des Fernsehers von 4 Stunden pro Tag,
365 Tage im Jahr. Der tatsächliche Wert ist abhängig
von der Verwendung des Fernsehers.
** Wenn der Fernseher über die Fernbedienung
ausgeschaltet wurde und keine Funktion aktiv ist.
Nutzungsende
Entsorgung von Altgeräten und Akkus
Ihr Gerät wurde unter Verwendung hochwertiger
Materialien und Komponenten entwickelt und
hergestellt, die recycelt und wiederverwendet werden
können.
Befindet sich dieses Symbol (durchgestrichene
Abfalltonne auf Rädern) auf dem Gerät, bedeutet
dies, dass für dieses Gerät die Europäische
Richtlinie 2012/19/EU gilt.
Informieren Sie sich über die örtlichen Bestimmungen
zur getrennten Sammlung elektrischer und
elektronischer Geräte.
Beachten Sie die geltenden regionalen
9
Bestimmungen, und entsorgen Sie Altgeräte nicht mit
dem normalen Hausmüll. Die korrekte Entsorgung des
nicht mehr benötigten Produkts hilft, negative
Auswirkungen auf Umwelt und Gesundheit zu
vermeiden.
Ihr Produkt enthält Akkus, die der Europäischen
Richtlinie 2006/66/EG unterliegen. Diese dürfen nicht
mit dem normalen Hausmüll entsorgt werden.
Informieren Sie sich über die getrennte Sammlung
von Batterien in Ihrem Land. Die korrekte Entsorgung
der Batterien hilft, negative Auswirkungen auf Umwelt
und Gesundheit zu vermeiden.
5.2
Leistung
Produktdaten können ohne Vorankündigung
geändert werden. Weitere Details zu den
Produktdaten finden Sie
unter www.philips.com/support.
Leistung
• Netzstrom: 220 bis 240 V Wechselstrom +/- 10 %
• Umgebungstemperatur: 5 °C bis 35 °C
• Energiesparfunktionen: Eco-Modus, Bildabschaltung
(bei Radiobetrieb), Ausschalt-Timer, Menü für
Energiespareinstellungen.
Informationen zum Energieverbrauch finden Sie im
Kapitel Produktdatenblatt.
5.3
Betriebssystem
Android OS:
Android Nougat 7
5.4
Empfang
• Antenneneingang: 75 Ohm koaxial (IEC75)
• Tuner-Band: Hyperband, S-Channel, UHF, VHF
• DVB: DVB-T2, DVB-C (Kabel) QAM
• Analoge Videowiedergabe: SECAM, PAL
• Digitale Videowiedergabe: MPEG2 SD/HD (ISO/IEC
13818-2), MPEG4 SD/HD (ISO/IEC 14496-10), HEVC*
• Digitale Audiowiedergabe (ISO/IEC 13818-3)
• Eingangsfrequenzbereich: 950 bis 2150 MHz
• Eingangspegel: 25 bis 65 dBm
* Nur für DVB-T2
5.5
Bildschirmtyp (6014U)
Bildschirmdiagonale:
• 108 cm (43")
• 126 cm (50")
• 139 cm (55")
• 164 cm (65")
Bildschirmauflösung
• 3840 x 2160
5.6
Bildschirmtyp (5014)
Bildschirmdiagonale:
• 80 cm (32")
• 108 cm (43")
• 126 cm (50")
Bildschirmauflösung
• 1.920 x 1.080
5.7
Bildschirmauflösung
(Eingang) (6014U)
Videoformate
Auflösung – Bildwiederholfrequenz
• 480i – 60 Hz
• 480p – 60 Hz
• 576i – 50 Hz
• 576p – 50 Hz
• 720p – 50 Hz, 60 Hz
• 1080i – 50 Hz, 60 Hz
• 1080p – 24 Hz, 25 Hz, 30 Hz
• 2160p – 24 Hz, 25 Hz, 30 Hz, 50 Hz, 60 Hz
Computerformate
Auflösungen (u. a.)
• 640 x 480 – 60 Hz
• 800 x 600 – 60 Hz
• 1024 x 768 – 60 Hz
• 1280 x 768 – 60 Hz
• 1360 x 765 – 60 Hz
• 1360 x 768 – 60 Hz
• 1280 x 1024 – 60 Hz
• 1920 x 1080 – 60 Hz
• 3840 x 2160 – 60 Hz
10
5.8
Bildschirmauflösung
(Eingang) (5014)
Videoformate
Auflösung – Bildwiederholfrequenz
• 480i – 60 Hz
• 480p – 60 Hz
• 576i – 50 Hz
• 576p – 50 Hz
• 720p – 50 Hz, 60 Hz
• 1080i – 50 Hz, 60 Hz
• 1080p – 24 Hz, 25 Hz, 30 Hz
Computerformate
Auflösungen (u. a.)
• 640 x 480 – 60 Hz
• 800 x 600 – 60 Hz
• 1024 x 768 – 60 Hz
• 1280 x 768 – 60 Hz
• 1360 x 765 – 60 Hz
• 1360 x 768 – 60 Hz
• 1280 x 1024 – 60 Hz
• 1920 x 1080 – 60 Hz
5.9
Konnektivität (6014U)
Seite des Fernsehers
• CI-Steckplatz: CI+/CAM
• USB 1 – USB 2.0
• USB 2 – USB 3.0
• Kopfhörer: 3,5 mm Stereo-Miniklinkenbuchse
• HDMI 1-Eingang, ARC, MHL, Ultra HD
• HDMI 2-Eingang, ARC, Ultra HD
TV-Unterseite
• Audio-Eingang VGA
• Netzwerk-LAN: RJ45
• HDMI 3-Eingang (ARC)
• Antenne (75 Ohm)
• USB 3 – USB 2.0
• Audioausgang – Optisch, Toslink
• VGA
TV-Rückseite
• 12 VDC-Ausgang
• 8 Audio-Ausgang
• DATA (RJ-48)
5.10
Konnektivität (5014)
Seite des Fernsehers
• CI-Steckplatz: CI+/CAM
• USB 1 – USB 3.0
• Kopfhörer: 3,5 mm Stereo-Miniklinkenbuchse
• HDMI 1-Eingang (ARC/MHL)
TV-Rückseite
• Netzwerk-LAN: RJ45
• HDMI 2-Eingang (ARC)
• Antenne (75 Ohm)
• USB 2 – USB 2.0
• Audioausgang – Optisch, Toslink
• 12 VDC-Ausgang
• 8 Audio-Ausgang
• DATA (RJ-48)
5.11
Abmessungen und Gewichte
43HFL6014U
• Ohne TV-Standfuß:
Breite: 971,3 mm, Höhe: 563,53 mm, Tiefe: 77,3 mm,
Gewicht: ±8,92 kg
• Mit TV-Standfuß:
Breite: 971,3 mm, Höhe: 628,61 mm, Tiefe: 205 mm,
Gewicht: ±11,37 kg
50HFL6014U
• Ohne TV-Standfuß:
Breite: 1128,4 mm, Höhe: 653 mm, Tiefe: 78,2 mm,
Gewicht: ±13,11 kg
• Mit TV-Standfuß:
Breite: 1128,4 mm, Höhe: 715,43 mm, Tiefe: 225 mm,
Gewicht: ±15,93 kg
55HFL6014U
• Ohne TV-Standfuß:
Breite: 1244,2 mm, Höhe: 719 mm, Tiefe: 78,4 mm,
Gewicht: ±18,44 kg
• Mit TV-Standfuß:
Breite: 1244,2 mm, Höhe: 783,9 mm, Tiefe: 225,2 mm,
Gewicht: ±21,29 kg
65HFL6014U
• Ohne TV-Standfuß:
Breite: 1462,3 mm, Höhe: 844,7 mm, Tiefe: 87,5 mm,
Gewicht: ± 24,45 kg
• Mit TV-Standfuß:
Breite: 1462,3 mm, Höhe: 905,75 mm, Tiefe: 279,1
mm, Gewicht: ±25,2 kg
32HFL5014
• Ohne TV-Standfuß:
Breite: 731,8 mm, Höhe: 435,31 mm, Tiefe: 77,3 mm,
Gewicht: ± 4,61 kg
• Mit TV-Standfuß:
11
Breite: 731,8 mm, Höhe: 494,14 mm, Tiefe: 179,31 mm,
Gewicht: ± 4,68 kg
43HFL5014
• Ohne TV-Standfuß:
Breite: 969,6 mm, Höhe: 565,6 mm, Tiefe: 80,5 mm,
Gewicht: ± 7,19 kg
• Mit TV-Standfuß:
Breite: 969,6 mm, Höhe: 624,2 mm, Tiefe: 194 mm,
Gewicht: ± 7,27 kg
50HFL5014
• Ohne TV-Standfuß:
Breite: 1127,6 mm, Höhe: 655,3 mm, Tiefe: 85,9 mm,
Gewicht: ± 11,25 kg
• Mit TV-Standfuß:
Breite: 1127,6 mm, Höhe: 714,8 mm, Tiefe: 218,9 mm,
Gewicht: ± 11,61 kg
5.12
Ton
• Ausgangsleistung (RMS): 20 W (32HFL5014/12:
16 W
• Dolby Audio
• DTS HD
12
6
Anschließen von
Geräten
6.1
Anschließen von Geräten
Verbindungsleitfaden
Verwenden Sie zum Anschließen eines Geräts an den
Fernseher immer den hochwertigsten Anschluss.
Verwenden Sie außerdem qualitativ hochwertige
Kabel, um eine gute Bild- und Tonübertragung
sicherzustellen.
Wenn Sie ein Gerät anschließen, erkennt der
Fernseher den entsprechenden Typ und ordnet dem
Gerät die richtige Typenbezeichnung zu. Bei Bedarf
können Sie den Typennamen ändern. Wenn eine
richtige Typenbezeichnung für ein Gerät festgelegt
wird, wechselt der Fernseher automatisch zu den
idealen Fernsehereinstellungen, wenn Sie im
Quellenmenü dieses Gerät auswählen.
Antennenanschluss
Wenn Sie über eine Set-Top-Box (einen
Digitalreceiver) oder einen Recorder verfügen,
schließen Sie die Kabel so an, dass das
Antennensignal zunächst durch die Set-Top-Box
bzw. den Recorder läuft, bevor es zum Fernseher
gelangt. Dadurch können die Antenne und die Set-
Top-Box zur Aufnahme mögliche zusätzliche Kanäle
an den Recorder senden.
HDMI-Anschlüsse
Steuern von Geräten
Um ein über HDMI angeschlossenes Gerät zu steuern
und EasyLink zu konfigurieren, wählen Sie das
Gerät – oder dessen Aktivität – aus der Liste der
Fernseheranschlüsse aus.
Profimodus AUS Drücken Sie Home, wählen
Sie Apps, und wählen Sie dann
SOURCES . Wählen Sie ein über HDMI
angeschlossenes Gerät aus, und drücken Sie OK.
Profimodus EIN Drücken Sie Home, wählen
Sie TV-Sender, und wählen Sie
dann Quellen. Wählen Sie ein über HDMI
angeschlossenes Gerät aus, und drücken Sie OK.
Sobald das Gerät ausgewählt wurde, kann es über die
Fernbedienung des Fernsehers gesteuert werden.
Allerdings werden die Tasten Home
und OPTIONS sowie einige weitere TV-Tasten
nicht an das Gerät weitergeleitet.
Wenn die benötigte Taste nicht auf der TV-
Fernbedienung zu finden ist, können Sie sie im Menü
Optionen wählen.
Drücken Sie OPTIONS und wählen
Sie Steuerungen in der Menüleiste. Wählen Sie auf
dem Bildschirm die gewünschte Gerätetaste aus, und
drücken Sie OK.
Einige sehr spezifische Gerätetasten sind
möglicherweise nicht im Steuerungsmenü verfügbar.
Hinweis: Nur Geräte, die die EasyLink-
Fernbedienungsfunktion unterstützen, reagieren auf
die Befehle der Fernbedienung des Fernsehers.
HDMI-Qualität
Ein HDMI-Anschluss bietet die beste Bild- und
Tonqualität. Ein einzelnes HDMI-Kabel kombiniert
Video- und Audiosignale. Verwenden Sie ein HDMI-
Kabel für das Fernsehsignal.
Verwenden Sie ein High Speed-HDMI-Kabel für
optimale Signalqualitätsübertragung, und verwenden
Sie kein HDMI-Kabel, das länger als 5 Meter ist.
Kopierschutz
HDMI-Kabel unterstützen HDCP (High-Bandwidth
Digital Content Protection). HDCP ist ein
Kopierschutzsignal, das verhindert, dass Inhalte von
einer DVD oder Blu-ray Disc kopiert werden. Es wird
auch DRM (Digital Rights Management) genannt.
HDMI ARC
Alle HDMI-Anschlüsse am Fernseher verfügen über
HDMI ARC (Audio Return Channel).
Wenn das Gerät, in der Regel ein Home
Entertainment-System (HES), ebenfalls über einen
HDMI ARC-Anschluss verfügt, schließen Sie es an
einen HDMI-Anschluss an diesem Fernseher an.
13
Durch die HDMI ARC-Verbindung benötigen Sie kein
separates Audiokabel zur Übertragung des Tons an
das HES. Über HDMI ARC werden sowohl Video- als
auch Audiosignale übertragen.
Zum Anschluss des HES am Fernseher können Sie
einen beliebigen HDMI-Anschluss verwenden, ARC
steht jedoch für jeweils nur ein Gerät bzw. eine
Verbindung zur Verfügung.
HDMI MHL
Mit HDMI MHL können Sie das, was Sie auf Ihrem
Android-Smartphone oder -Tablet sehen, an einen
Fernsehbildschirm senden.
Der HDMI 1-Anschluss bei diesem Fernseher
beinhaltet MHL 2.0 (Mobile High-Definition Link).
Diese kabelgebundene Verbindung bietet
hervorragende Stabilität und Bandbreite, geringe
Latenzzeiten, keine Interferenzen sowie eine
hochwertige Tonwiedergabe. Darüber hinaus wird
durch die MHL-Verbindung der Akku Ihres
Smartphones bzw. Tablets aufgeladen. Das mobile
Gerät lädt allerdings nicht, wenn sich der Fernseher
im Standby-Modus befindet.
Informieren Sie sich, welches passive MHL-Kabel für
Ihr mobiles Gerät geeignet ist. Achten Sie hierbei
insbesondere darauf, welchen Stecker Sie – neben
dem HDMI-Anschluss für den Fernseher auf der
einen Seite – für das Smartphone bzw. Tablet
benötigen.
MHL, Mobile High-Definition Link und das MHL-Logo
sind Marken oder eingetragene Marken der MHL, LLC.
HDMI CEC – EasyLink
Ein HDMI-Anschluss bietet die beste Bild- und
Tonqualität. Ein einzelnes HDMI-Kabel kombiniert
Video- und Audiosignale. Verwenden Sie ein HDMI-
Kabel für Fernsehsignale im HD-Format (High
Definition). Verwenden Sie ein High Speed-HDMI-
Kabel für optimale Signalqualitätsübertragung, und
verwenden Sie kein HDMI-Kabel, das länger als
5 Meter ist.
Verbinden Sie HDMI CEC-kompatible Geräte mit
Ihrem Fernseher. Sie können diese dann mit der
Fernbedienung des Fernsehers bedienen.
Dazu muss EasyLink HDMI CEC auf dem Fernseher
und dem angeschlossenen Gerät eingeschaltet sein.
Hinweis:
• EasyLink funktioniert unter Umständen nicht mit
Geräten anderer Hersteller.
• Die HDMI-CEC-Funktionalität wird bei
verschiedenen Marken unterschiedlich benannt.
Einige Beispiele sind: Anynet, Aquos Link, Bravia
Theatre Sync, Kuro Link, Simplink und Viera Link.
Nicht alle Marken sind vollständig mit EasyLink
kompatibel. Als Beispiel genannte HDMI-CEC-
Marken sind Eigentum der jeweiligen Inhaber.
EasyLink Ein/Aus
Sie können EasyLink ein- oder ausschalten.
Standardmäßig sind alle EasyLink-Einstellungen des
Fernsehers aktiviert.
So schalten Sie EasyLink vollständig aus:
Profimodus AUS Drücken Sie Home und dann
(nach unten), und wählen Sie Einstellungen
gefolgt von OK.
Wählen Sie Quellen > EasyLink aus, und drücken
Sie OK .
Wählen Sie EasyLink aus, und drücken Sie OK.
Wählen Sie Aus, und drücken Sie die Taste OK.
Drücken Sie gegebenenfalls mehrmals BACK, um
14
das Menü zu beenden.
Profimodus EIN Bitte lesen Sie im
Installationshandbuch nach.
EasyLink-Fernbedienung
Wenn Sie möchten, dass Geräte zwar miteinander
kommunizieren, nicht jedoch über die Fernbedienung
des Fernsehers gesteuert werden, können Sie die
EasyLink-Fernbedienung auch separat deaktivieren.
So aktivieren bzw. deaktivieren Sie die EasyLink-
Fernbedienung:
Profimodus AUS Drücken Sie Home. Drücken
Sie (nach unten), wählen Sie Einstellungen und
drücken Sie OK.
Wählen Sie Quellen > EasyLink aus, und drücken
Sie OK .
Wählen Sie EasyLink-Fernbedienung aus, und
drücken Sie OK.
Wählen Sie Ein oder Aus, und drücken Sie OK.
Drücken Sie gegebenenfalls mehrmals BACK, um
das Menü zu beenden.
Profimodus EIN Bitte lesen Sie im
Installationshandbuch nach.
6.2
CAM mit Smart Card – CI+
CI+
Dieser Fernseher ist kompatibel mit CI+ Conditional
Access-Modulen (CAM).
Mit CI+ können Sie Premium-HD-Programme
ansehen, wie Filme oder Sport, die von digitalen
Fernsehsendern in Ihrer Region angeboten werden.
Diese Programme werden von den Fernsehsendern
verschlüsselt und können mit einem erworbenen
CI+-Modul entschlüsselt werden.
Wenn Sie Premium-Programme eines digitalen
Fernsehanbieters abonnieren, erhalten Sie von
diesem ein CI+-Modul (Conditional Access Module,
CAM) sowie eine zugehörige Smart Card. Diese
Programme verfügen über einen strengen
Kopierschutz.
Wenden Sie sich an einen digitalen Fernsehbetreiber,
um weitere Informationen zu den Bedingungen zu
erhalten.
Smart Card
Wenn die Premium-Programme eines digitalen
Fernsehanbieters abonnieren, erhalten Sie von
diesem ein CI+-Modul (Conditional Access Module,
CAM) sowie eine zugehörige Smart Card.
Stecken Sie die Smart Card in das CA-Modul.
Berücksichtigen Sie dabei an die Anweisungen des
Betreibers.
So stecken Sie das CA-Modul in den Fernseher:
1 - Achten Sie beim Einstecken des CA-Moduls auf
die richtige Ausrichtung. Eine falsche Ausrichtung
kann das CA-Modul und den Fernseher beschädigen.
2 - Stecken Sie das CA-Modul mit der Vorderseite zu
Ihnen gerichtet in den Anschluss COMMON
INTERFACE auf der Rückseite des Fernsehers.
3 - Drücken Sie das CA-Modul so weit wie möglich
hinein. Lassen Sie es dauerhaft in dem Steckplatz.
Wenn Sie den Fernseher einschalten, kann es
möglicherweise etwas dauern, bis das CA-Modul
aktiviert wird. Wenn ein CAM eingesetzt und das
Abonnement bezahlt wurde, (wobei sich die
Verbindungsmethoden unterscheiden können),
können Sie die von der CAM Smart Card unterstützten
verschlüsselten Sender ansehen.
Das CAM und die Smart Card sind ausschließlich für
Ihren Fernseher vorgesehen. Wenn Sie das CAM
entfernen, können Sie die vom CAM unterstützten
verschlüsselten Sender nicht mehr ansehen.
6.3
Receiver – Set-Top-Box
Schließen Sie die Antenne mit zwei Antennenkabeln
an die Set-Top-Box (einen Digitalreceiver) und den
Fernseher an.
15
Zusätzlich zu den Antennenverbindungen benötigen
Sie ein HDMI-Kabel zum Anschließen der Set-Top-
Box an den Fernseher.
6.4
Home Entertainment-System
– HES
Verbinden mit HDMI ARC
Schließen Sie ein Home Entertainment-System (HES)
über ein HDMI-Kabel an den Fernseher an. Sie
können einen Philips SoundBar oder ein HES mit
einem integrierten Disc-Player anschließen.
HDMI ARC
Wenn Ihr Home Entertainment-System über einen
HDMI ARC-Anschluss verfügt, können Sie einen
beliebigen HDMI-Anschluss am Gerät zum Verbinden
verwenden. Mit HDMI ARC müssen Sie kein
separates Audiokabel anschließen. Über HDMI ARC
werden sowohl Video- als auch Audiosignale
übertragen.
Alle HDMI-Anschlüsse am Fernseher können das ARC-
Signal (Audio Return Channel) übertragen. Sobald Sie
das Home Entertainment-System angeschlossen
haben, kann der Fernseher das ARC-Signal jedoch
nur an diesen HDMI-Anschluss senden.
Audio-Video-Synchronisierung (Sync)
Wenn der Ton nicht dem Video auf dem Bildschirm
entspricht, können Sie bei den meisten Home
Entertainment-Systemen mit Disc-Player eine
Verzögerung einstellen, um Ton und Video
aneinander anzupassen.
Verbinden mit HDMI
Schließen Sie ein Home Entertainment-System (HES)
über ein HDMI-Kabel an den Fernseher an. Sie
können einen Philips SoundBar oder ein HES mit
einem integrierten Disc-Player anschließen.
Wenn das Home Entertainment-System keinen HDMI
ARC-Anschluss aufweist, verwenden Sie ein
optisches Audiokabel (Toslink), um den Ton des
Fernsehers an das Home Entertainment-System zu
übertragen.
Audio-Video-Synchronisierung (Sync)
Wenn der Ton nicht dem Video auf dem Bildschirm
entspricht, können Sie bei den meisten Home
Entertainment-Systemen mit Disc-Player eine
Verzögerung einstellen, um Ton und Video
aneinander anzupassen.
6.5
Smartphones und Tablets
Zur Verbindung eines Smartphones oder Tablets mit
dem Fernseher können Sie eine kabellose oder
kabelgebundene Verbindung verwenden.
Kabellos
16
Wenn Sie die Verbindung kabellos durchführen
möchten, laden Sie die Philips TV Remote App von
Ihrer bevorzugten App-Plattform auf das Smartphone
bzw. Tablet herunter.
Kabelgebunden
Wenn Sie eine kabelgebundene Verbindung
durchführen möchten, verwenden Sie den HDMI 1
MHL-Anschluss auf der Rückseite des Fernsehers.
6.6
Blu-ray Disc-Player
Verbinden Sie den Blu-ray Disc-Player über ein High
Speed-HDMI-Kabel mit dem Fernseher.
Wenn der Blu-ray Disc-Player über EasyLink HDMI-
CEC verfügt, können Sie den Player mit der
Fernbedienung des Fernsehers steuern.
6.7
Kopfhörer
Sie können Kopfhörer an der Rückseite des
Fernsehers am Anschluss anschließen. Dies ist ein
Anschluss für einen 3,5 mm Miniklinkenstecker. Sie
können die Lautstärke der Kopfhörer getrennt
einstellen.
6.8
Spielekonsole
HDMI
Beste Qualität erzielen Sie, wenn Sie ein High Speed-
HDMI-Kabel zum Anschließen der Spielkonsole an
den Fernseher verwenden.
6.9
USB-Flashlaufwerk
Sie können Fotos, Musik oder Videos von einem
angeschlossenen USB-Flashlaufwerk wiedergeben.
Stecken Sie ein USB-Flashlaufwerk in einen der
USB-Anschlüsse des eingeschalteten Fernsehers.
Der Fernseher erkennt das Flashlaufwerk und öffnet
eine Liste mit dessen Inhalten.
Wenn die Inhaltsliste nicht automatisch angezeigt
wird...
Profimodus AUS Drücken Sie Home,
und wählen Sie Apps gefolgt
von Quellen. Wählen Sie USB aus, und drücken
Sie OK.
Profimodus Ein Drücken Sie Home, und
wählen Sie TV-Sender gefolgt
von SOURCES . Wählen Sie USB aus, und
drücken Sie OK.
Um die Wiedergabe der Inhalte auf dem USB-
Flashlaufwerk zu beenden, drücken Sie , oder
wählen Sie eine andere Aktivität aus.
Wenn Sie das USB-Flashlaufwerk vom Fernseher
trennen möchten, können Sie es jederzeit
herausziehen.
17
6.10
Computer
Verbinden
Sie können Ihren Computer an den Fernseher
anschließen, und den Fernseher als
Computerbildschirm verwenden.
Über HDMI
Verbinden Sie den Computer über ein HDMI-Kabel
mit dem Fernseher.
Mit VGA (6014U)
Verwenden Sie ein VGA-Kabel zum Anschließen des
Computers an den Fernseher und ein Audiokabel
(Miniklinkenbuchse 3,5 mm) für den AUDIO-
EINGANG VGA an der Rückseite des Fernsehers.
Ideale Einstellung
Bei der Verbindung eines Computers sollten Sie dem
Anschluss, an den der Computer angeschlossen ist,
den richtigen Gerätetyp im Menü "Quelle"
zuzuweisen. Wenn Sie im Menü Quelle zu Computer
wechseln, wird der Fernseher automatisch auf die
ideale Computer-Einstellung eingestellt.
So legen Sie auf dem Fernseher die ideale Einstellung
fest:
Profimodus AUS Drücken Sie Home. Drücken
Sie (nach unten), wählen Sie Einstellungen, und
drücken Sie OK.
Wählen Sie Bild aus, und drücken Sie (rechts), um
das Menü zu öffnen. Wählen
Sie Bildeinstellung > Computer , und drücken
Sie OK.
Wählen Sie Ein oder Aus, und drücken Sie OK.
Drücken Sie gegebenenfalls mehrmals , um das
Menü zu schließen.
Profimodus EIN Drücken
Sie Home > Mehr >
Einstellungen > Bild. Drücken Sie OK.
Wählen Sie Bildeinstellung > Computer , und
drücken Sie OK.
Wählen Sie Ein oder Aus, und drücken Sie OK.
Drücken Sie gegebenenfalls mehrmals , um das
Menü zu schließen.
(Informationen zum Profimodus finden Sie in der
Installationsanleitung)
18
7
Videos, Fotos und
Musik
7.1
Über eine USB-Verbindung
Sie können Ihre Fotos, Musik oder Videos von einem
angeschlossenen USB-Flashlaufwerk oder eine USB-
Festplatte wiedergeben.
Schließen Sie bei eingeschaltetem Fernseher ein USB-
Flashlaufwerk oder eine USB-Festplatte an einen der
USB-Anschlüsse an. Das Gerät wird vom Fernseher
erkannt, und eine Liste Ihrer Mediendateien wird
angezeigt.
Wenn die Liste der Dateien nicht automatisch
angezeigt wird:
1 - Drücken Sie SENDER und wählen
Sie Quellen.
2 - Wählen Sie Medien und drücken Sie OK.
3 - Sie können Ihre Dateien in der Ordnerstruktur auf
dem Laufwerk durchsuchen.
4 - Zum Stoppen der Wiedergabe von Videos, Fotos
und Musik drücken Sie .
7.2
Wiedergeben Ihrer Videos
Wiedergeben von Videos
Öffnen eines Videoordners
1 - Drücken Sie SENDER und wählen
Sie Quellen.
2 - Wählen Sie Medien und Videos, und
drücken Sie dann OK.
Um zurück zum Ordner zu wechseln, drücken Sie .
Wiedergeben eines Videos
1 - Drücken Sie SENDER und wählen
Sie Quellen.
2 - Wählen Sie Medien und Videos, und
drücken Sie dann OK.
3 - Wählen Sie eines der Videos aus. Durch Drücken
von Alle wiedergeben können Sie alle Dateien
im Ordner wiedergeben, oder drücken Sie Als
Favoriten markieren, um das ausgewählte Video zum
Favoritenmenü hinzuzufügen – Favoriten.
Um das Video zu unterbrechen, drücken Sie OK.
Drücken Sie OK erneut, um die Wiedergabe
fortzusetzen.
Steuerleiste
Um die Steuerleiste ein- oder auszublenden, wenn
ein Video abgespielt wird, drücken Sie OK.
1 - Fortschrittsanzeige
2 - Steuerleiste für die Wiedergabe
- : Zum vorherigen Video in einem Ordner springen
- : Zum nächsten Video in einem Ordner springen
- : Rücklauf
- : Schnellvorlauf
- : Pausieren der Wiedergabe
3 - Als Favorit markieren
4 - Wiedergeben aller Videos
5 - Untertitel: Ein- oder Ausschalten der Untertitel
und Aus- oder Einschalten der Untertitel bei einer
Tonunterbrechung
6 - Untertitelsprache: Wählen Sie eine
Untertitelsprache aus (nicht verfügbar für den
Profimodus EIN).
7 - Audiosprache: Auswählen einer Audiosprache
8 - Zufallswiedergabe: Wiedergeben Ihrer Dateien in
zufälliger Reihenfolge
9 - Wiederholen: Einmaliges oder wiederholtes
Wiedergeben aller Videos in diesem Ordner
Videooptionen
Drücken Sie während der
Videowiedergabe OPTIONS, wählen Sie Info,
und drücken Sie OK, um...
Als Favorit markieren – Die ausgewählten Videos
werden als Favorit eingerichtet.
Alle wdg. – Alle Videodateien in diesem Ordner
werden wiedergegeben.
Untertitel – Für die Untertitel können Sie die
Einstellungen Ein, Aus oder Ein +
Tonunterbrechung festlegen.
Audiosprache – Wählen Sie, sofern verfügbar, eine
Audiosprache aus.
Shuffle – Ihre Dateien werden in zufälliger
Reihenfolge wiedergegeben.
Wiederholen – Alle Videos in diesem Ordner
werden einmal oder wiederholt wiedergegeben.
19
7.3
Anzeigen Ihrer Fotos
Anzeigen von Fotos
Öffnen eines Fotoordners
1 - Drücken Sie CHANNELS und wählen
Sie Quellen.
2 - Wählen Sie Medien und Fotos, und
drücken Sie dann OK.
Anzeigen von Fotos
1 - Drücken Sie SENDER und wählen
Sie Quellen.
2 - Wählen Sie Medien und Fotos, und
drücken Sie dann OK.
3 - Wählen Sie Fotos aus, und wählen Sie eines der
Fotos aus. Durch Drücken von Diashow können
Sie alle Dateien im Ordner wiedergeben, oder
drücken Sie Favorit markieren, um das
ausgewählte Foto zum Favoritenmenü hinzuzufügen
Favoriten.
Steuerleiste
1 - Steuerleiste für die Wiedergabe
- : Zum vorherigen Foto in einem Ordner springen
- : Zum nächsten Foto in einem Ordner springen
- : Pausieren der Diashow-Wiedergabe
2 - Als Favorit markieren
3 - Starten einer Diashow
4 - Drehen des Fotos
5 - Zufallswiedergabe: Wiedergeben Ihrer Dateien in
zufälliger Reihenfolge
6 - Wiederholen: Einmaliges oder wiederholtes
Wiedergeben aller Fotos in diesem Ordner
7 - Beenden der Musikwiedergabe im Hintergrund
(nicht verfügbar im Profimodus EIN)
8 - Bestimmen der Geschwindigkeit der Diashow
Fotooptionen
Drücken Sie während der
Videowiedergabe OPTIONS, wählen Sie Info und
drücken Sie OK, um...
• Als Favorit markieren
• Starten einer Diashow
• Drehen des Fotos
• Zufallswiedergabe: Wiedergeben Ihrer Dateien in
zufälliger Reihenfolge
• Wiederholen: Einmaliges oder wiederholtes
Wiedergeben aller Fotos in diesem Ordner
• Beenden der Musikwiedergabe im Hintergrund
(nicht verfügbar im Profimodus EIN)
• Bestimmen der Geschwindigkeit der Diashow
7.4
Wiedergeben Ihrer Musik
Geben Sie Musik wieder
Musikordner öffnen
1 - Drücken Sie CHANNELS und wählen
Sie Quellen.
2 - Wählen Sie Medien und Musik, und
drücken Sie dann OK.
Musik wiedergeben
1 - Drücken Sie CHANNELS und wählen
Sie Quellen.
2 - Wählen Sie Medien und Musik, und
drücken Sie dann OK.
3 - Sie können durch Drücken von Favorit
markieren den Musikordner zum Favoritenmenü
hinzufügen – Favoriten.
4 - Über die Klassifizierung können Sie Musiktitel
ganz einfach
finden: Genres, Künstler, Alben, Tracks.
Steuerleiste
1 - Fortschrittsanzeige
2 - Steuerleiste für die Wiedergabe
- : Zum vorherigen Musiktitel in einem Ordner
20
springen
- : Zum nächsten Musiktitel in einem Ordner
springen
- : Rücklauf
- : Schnellvorlauf
- : Pausieren der Wiedergabe
3 - Als Favorit markieren
4 - Wiedergeben aller Musiktitel
5 - Zufallswiedergabe: Wiedergeben Ihrer Dateien in
zufälliger Reihenfolge
6 - Wiederholen: Einmaliges oder wiederholtes
Wiedergeben aller Musiktitel in diesem Ordner
Musikoptionen
Drücken Sie während der Musikwiedergabe
auf OPTIONS, und wählen Sie Info gefolgt von
OK, um...
• Als Favorit markieren
• Wiedergeben aller Musiktitel
• Zufallswiedergabe: Wiedergeben Ihrer Dateien in
zufälliger Reihenfolge
• Wiederholen: Einmaliges oder wiederholtes
Wiedergeben aller Musiktitel in diesem Ordner
21
8
TV-Guide
8.1
Verwenden des TV-Guide
Öffnen des TV-Guide
Um den TV-Guide zu öffnen, drücken
Sie TV-GUIDE . Der TV-Guide zeigt die Sender
des ausgewählten Tuners an.
Drücken Sie zum Beenden erneut TV GUIDE .
Wenn Sie den TV-Guide das erste Mal öffnen,
durchsucht der Fernseher alle Sender nach
Programminformationen. Dies kann einige Minuten
dauern. Die Daten des TV-Guide werden auf dem
Fernseher gespeichert.
22
9
Spiele
9.1
Spielen
Von einer Spielkonsole
So starten Sie ein Spiel über eine Spielkonsole:
Schalten Sie die Spielkonsole ein.
Profimodus AUS Drücken Sie Home, und
wählen Sie Apps. Wählen Sie Quellen, und
drücken Sie OK.
Starten Sie das Spiel.
Drücken Sie wiederholt BACK oder drücken
Sie EXIT, oder beenden Sie die App mit der
zugehörigen Schaltfläche zum Beenden/Stoppen.
Drücken Sie zur Anzeige weiterer Informationen zum
Verbinden einer Spielkonsole in der Hilfe die
Farbtaste Suchbegriffe , und öffnen
Sie Spielkonsole, Anschließen.
Profimodus EIN Drücken Sie SOURCES und
wählen Sie eine Spielekonsole oder den Namen der
Verbindung.
Starten Sie das Spiel.
Drücken Sie wiederholt BACK oder drücken
Sie EXIT, oder beenden Sie die App mit der
zugehörigen Schaltfläche zum Beenden/Stoppen.
Drücken Sie zur Anzeige weiterer Informationen zum
Verbinden einer Spielkonsole in der Hilfe die
Farbtaste Suchbegriffe , und öffnen
Sie Spielkonsole, Anschließen.
Durch Apps
So starten Sie ein Spiel über eine Spiele-App:
Profimodus Aus Drücken Sie Home, und
wählen Sie Apps gefolgt von Google Play
Games.
Melden Sie sich bei Ihrem Google-Konto an, und
starten Sie ein Spiel.
Drücken Sie wiederholt BACK, oder drücken Sie
EXIT, oder beenden Sie die App mit der
zugehörigen Schaltfläche zum Beenden/Stoppen.
Profimodus EIN Drücken Sie Home. Wählen
Sie Spiele.
Melden Sie sich bei Ihrem Google-Konto an, und
starten Sie ein Spiel.
Drücken Sie wiederholt BACK, oder drücken Sie
EXIT, oder beenden Sie die App mit der
zugehörigen Schaltfläche zum Beenden/Stoppen.
23
10
Professional-Menü-
App
10.1
Info zur Professional-Menü-
App
In der Professional-Menü-App können Sie alle
Aktivitäten starten, die sich über den Fernseher
ausführen lassen.
Der linke Teil der Professional-Menü-App ist in Zeilen
organisiert...
• Empfohlen
• Fernsehsender
• Cast
• Spiele
• Mehr
Der obere rechte Teil der Professional-Menü-App ist
in Zeilen angeordnet.
• Konto verwalten
• Nachrichten (Dies ist eine optionale Funktion,
die von den internen Einstellungen des Hotels
abhängig ist.)
• Rechnung (Dies ist eine optionale Funktion, die
von den internen Einstellungen des Hotels abhängig
ist.)
• Einstellen des Alarms
• Wetter
• Menüsprache
• Aktuelle Zeit
10.2
Professional-Menü-App
öffnen
Profimodus AUS - Siehe Kapitel "Android TV-
Startbildschirm".
Profimodus EIN - Zum Öffnen der Professional-Menü-
App und Öffnen eines Elements...
1 - Öffnen Sie die Professional-Menü-App durch
Drücken von Home .
2 - Wählen Sie mit den Pfeiltasten eine Aktivität aus,
und drücken Sie OK, um die Aktivität zu starten.
3 - Um die Professional-Menü-App ohne Änderung
der aktuellen Aktivität zu schließen, drücken Sie .
Wenn Sie die Professional-Menü-App öffnen, wird
die im Hintergrund ausgeführte
Anwendung/Inhaltswiedergabe angehalten. Wählen
Sie zum Fortsetzen die Anwendung bzw. den Inhalt
über die Professional-Menü-App aus.
10.3
Empfohlen
So öffnen Sie die Professional-Menü-App und den
Befehl Empfohlen...
1 - Öffnen Sie die Professional-Menü-App.
2 - Wählen Sie Empfohlen , und drücken Sie OK,
um es zu öffnen oder zu starten.
3 - Wählen Sie Empfohlene Fernsehsender.
Wählen Sie einen Sender aus der Liste und drücken
Sie OK.
4 - Wählen Sie Apps. Wählen Sie aus der Liste
eine App und drücken Sie die Taste OK.
10.4
Fernsehsender
Senderlisten
Informationen zu Senderlisten
Nach der Senderinstallation werden alle Sender in der
Senderliste angezeigt. Sender werden mit Name und
Logo angezeigt, sofern diese Informationen verfügbar
sind.
Wenn eine Senderliste ausgewählt ist, können Sie mit
den Pfeiltasten (nach oben) oder (nach unten)
einen Sender auswählen. Drücken Sie dann OK, um
den ausgewählten Sender anzusehen. Sie können mit
den Tasten   oder   nur die in dieser Liste
enthaltenen Sender einschalten.
24
Radiosender
Wenn digitale Sendungen verfügbar sind, werden
während der Installation auch digitale Radiosender
installiert. Sie können wie bei Fernsehprogrammen
zwischen Radiosendern wechseln.
Öffnen einer Senderliste
So öffnen Sie die aktuelle Senderliste:
1. Drücken Sie , um zum Fernsehen zu wechseln.
2. Drücken Sie CHANNELS, um die aktuelle
Senderliste zu öffnen. Wählen Sie Alle Sender,
um sowohl Fernseh- als auch Radiosender
anzuzeigen. Wählen Sie , um nur TV-Sender
anzuzeigen. Wählen Sie , um nur Radiosender
anzuzeigen.
3. Drücken Sie CHANNELS erneut, um die
Senderliste zu schließen.
Anzeigen von Sendern
Einschalten eines Senders
Um Fernsehsender anzuzeigen, drücken Sie . Der
Fernseher schaltet automatisch auf den Sender, den
Sie zuletzt gesehen haben.
Umschalten der Sender
- Um zwischen den Sendern umzuschalten, drücken
Sie   oder  .
Vorheriger Sender
- Wenn Sie zurück zum zuvor wiedergegebenen
Sender wechseln möchten, drücken Sie BACK.
Senderliste
Drücken Sie beim Fernsehen die Taste , um die
Senderliste zu öffnen.
Senderoptionen
Öffnen der Optionen
Beim Fernsehen können Sie einige Optionen
festlegen.
Je nach Art des wiedergegebenen Senders (analog
oder digital) bzw. je nach Fernsehereinstellungen
stehen unterschiedliche Optionen zur Verfügung.
So öffnen Sie das Optionsmenü:
1 - Drücken Sie während der Senderwiedergabe
OPTIONS.
2 - Drücken Sie zum Beenden erneut OPTIONS.
10.5
Fernsehsender
Senderlisten
Informationen zu Senderlisten
Nach der Senderinstallation werden alle Sender in der
Senderliste angezeigt. Sender werden mit Name und
Logo angezeigt, sofern diese Informationen verfügbar
sind.
Wenn eine Senderliste ausgewählt ist, können Sie mit
den Pfeiltasten (nach oben) oder (nach unten)
einen Sender auswählen. Drücken Sie dann OK, um
den ausgewählten Sender anzusehen. Sie können mit
den Tasten   oder   nur die in dieser Liste
enthaltenen Sender einschalten.
Radiosender
Wenn digitale Sendungen verfügbar sind, werden
während der Installation auch digitale Radiosender
installiert. Sie können wie bei Fernsehprogrammen
zwischen Radiosendern wechseln.
Öffnen einer Senderliste
So öffnen Sie die aktuelle Senderliste:
1. Drücken Sie , um zum Fernsehen zu wechseln.
2. Drücken Sie CHANNELS, um die aktuelle
Senderliste zu öffnen. Wählen Sie Alle Sender,
um sowohl Fernseh- als auch Radiosender
anzuzeigen. Wählen Sie , um nur TV-Sender
anzuzeigen. Wählen Sie , um nur Radiosender
anzuzeigen.
3. Drücken Sie CHANNELS erneut, um die
Senderliste zu schließen.
Anzeigen von Sendern
Einschalten eines Senders
Um Fernsehsender anzuzeigen, drücken Sie . Der
Fernseher schaltet automatisch auf den Sender, den
Sie zuletzt gesehen haben.
Umschalten der Sender
- Um zwischen den Sendern umzuschalten, drücken
Sie oder
Vorheriger Sender
Wenn Sie zurück zum zuvor wiedergegebenen Sender
wechseln möchten, drücken Sie BACK.
Senderliste
25
Drücken Sie beim Fernsehen die Taste , um die
Senderliste zu öffnen.
Senderoptionen
Öffnen der Optionen
Beim Fernsehen können Sie einige Optionen
festlegen.
Je nach Art des wiedergegebenen Senders (analog
oder digital) bzw. je nach Fernsehereinstellungen
stehen unterschiedliche Optionen zur Verfügung.
So öffnen Sie das Optionsmenü:
1 - Drücken Sie während der Senderwiedergabe
OPTIONS.
2 - Drücken Sie zum Beenden erneut OPTIONS.
10.6
Google Cast
Was Sie benötigen
Wenn eine Anwendung auf Ihrem Mobilgerät über
Google Cast verfügt, können Sie Ihre App auf diesem
Fernseher wiedergeben. Suchen Sie in der mobilen
App nach dem Google Cast-Symbol. Sie können mit
Ihrem Mobilgerät steuern, was auf dem Fernseher
angezeigt werden soll. Google Cast funktioniert unter
Android und iOS.
Ihr Mobilgerät muss mit dem gleichen WiFi-
Heimnetzwerk wie Ihr Fernseher verbunden sein.
Apps mit Google Cast
Neue Google Cast-Apps erscheinen täglich. Sie
können diese Funktion bereits mit YouTube, Chrome,
Netflix, Photowall … oder Big Web Quiz für
Chromecast ausprobieren. Siehe auch:
google.com/cast
Einige Google Play-Produkte und -Funktionen sind
nicht in allen Ländern verfügbar.
Weitere Informationen finden Sie
unter support.google.com/androidtv
Wiedergeben von Inhalten auf dem
Fernseher
So geben Sie eine App auf dem Fernsehbildschirm
wieder:
So öffnen Sie die Professional-Menü-App und den
Befehl Cast...
1 - Öffnen Sie die Professional-Menü-App.
2 - Wählen Sie Cast , und drücken Sie OK, um
es zu öffnen oder zu starten.
3 - Verbinden Sie das Smartphone über Wi-Fi Direct
mit dem Fernseher (scannen Sie den QR-Code oder
verwenden Sie die WiFi-SSID und das
Passwort). Öffnen Sie eine App, die Google Cast
unterstützt.
4 - Tippen Sie auf das Google Cast-Symbol.
5 - Wählen Sie den Fernseher aus, auf dem Sie die
Wiedergabe durchführen möchten.
6 - Drücken Sie auf Ihrem Smartphone oder Tablet
"Wiedergabe". Ihre Auswahl sollte nun auf dem
Fernseher wiedergegeben werden.
10.7
Spiele
So öffnen Sie die Professional-Menü-App und die
Spiele...
1 - Öffnen Sie die Professional-Menü-App.
2 - Wählen Sie Spiele , und drücken Sie OK.
Ideale Spieleinstellung
Für einige Spiele, bei denen Geschwindigkeit und
Präzision wichtig sind, können Sie den Fernseher vor
Beginn des Spiels mit den idealen Einstellungen für
Spiele einrichten.
Wenn Ihre Spielkonsole als Gerät des Typs Spiel im
Quellenmenü (Liste aller Anschlüsse) hinzugefügt
wurde, werden am Fernseher automatisch die idealen
Spieleinstellungen vorgenommen.
Wenn für die Spielkonsole der
Typ Player festgelegt wurde und Sie sie die meiste
Zeit als Disc-Player verwenden, sollten Sie die
Einstellung Player nicht ändern.
So stellen Sie die idealen Einstellungen manuell auf
dem Fernseher ein: . .
1 - Wählen Sie Home > Mehr
> Einstellungen > Bild > Bildeinstellung.
2 - Wählen Sie Spiel, und drücken Sie die Taste OK.
3 - Drücken Sie gegebenenfalls mehrmals , um
das Menü zu beenden. Achten Sie darauf, die
Einstellung "Spiel" oder "Computer" wieder auf Aus zu
setzen, wenn Sie mit dem Spielen fertig sind.
10.8
Mehr
So öffnen Sie die Professional-Menü-App und Mehr...
1 - Öffnen Sie die Professional-Menü-App.
2 - Wählen Sie Mehr aus, und drücken Sie OK,
um es zu öffnen oder zu starten.
3 - Wählen Sie Einstellungen.
26
• Bild :
Wechseln Sie zwischen den Bildvoreinstellungen. Es
gibt ideale Einstellungen für die Wiedergabe von
Filmen oder Fotos usw.
• Ton :
Wechselt zwischen den voreingestellten
Toneinstellungen. Es gibt ideale Einstellungen für
Filme, Musik oder Spiele.
• Bildformat :
Wählen Sie für den Bildschirm ein passendes
Bildformat aus.
• Menüsprache :
Wählen Sie Ihre Sprache aus, und drücken Sie OK.
4 - Wählen Sie Funktionen, und drücken Sie OK.
• Einstellen des Alarms :
Am Fernseher kann ein Alarm eingestellt werden. Der
Fernseher kann sich zu einer festgelegten Weckzeit
einschalten. Legen Sie alternativ die Alarmzeit fest,
indem Sie die Taste auf der Fernbedienung
drücken.
• Sleep-Timer :
Mit dem Schieberegler können Sie den Sleeptimer in
Schritten von 5 Minuten auf bis zu 180 Minuten
einstellen. Wenn Sie ihn auf 0 Minuten einstellen, ist
der Sleeptimer ausgeschaltet. Sie können den
Fernseher jederzeit früher ausschalten oder die Zeit
während des Countdowns zurücksetzen.
• Wetter :
Anzeige der beobachteten Temperatur, enthält
5-Tages-Wettervorhersage für den aktuellen
Standort. Legen Sie alternativ die Alarmzeit fest,
indem Sie die Taste auf der Fernbedienung
drücken.
5 - Wählen Sie Persönlich , und drücken Sie OK.
Rechnung : Der Hotelgast kann während seines
Aufenthalts seine Hotelrechnung einsehen. (Nur im
Profimodus EIN.)
Nachrichten :
Gäste werden benachrichtigt, wenn neue
Nachrichten vom Hotel auf dem Fernseher
eingehen. (Nur im Profimodus EIN.)
Nachrichtenanzeige :
Anzeige von Benachrichtigungen ändern. (Nur im
Profimodus EIN.)
Konto verwalten :
Stellen Sie bei der Anmeldung beim Google-Konto
über Telefon oder Laptop sicher, dass das Telefon
oder der Laptop mit demselben Netzwerk wie der
Fernseher verbunden ist, und geben Sie dann den
auf dem Fernseher angezeigten Code ein, um die
Anmeldung abzuschließen. Der Gast kann sich auch
mit der E-Mail-Adresse und dem Passwort eines
Google-Kontos anmelden.
Verlauf löschen :
Löschen aller persönliche Anmeldedaten von allen
Anwendungen (beim Auschecken aus dem Hotel
werden alle Daten automatisch gelöscht, nur im
Profimodus EIN)
10.9
Professional Settings
Bildeinstellung
Auswählen einer Einstellung
Drücken Sie Home > Mehr
> Einstellungen > Bild > Bildeinstellung.
Zur einfachen Anpassung des Bildes können Sie eine
vordefinierte Bildeinstellung auswählen.
• Persönlich – Die Bildoptionen, die Sie beim ersten
Öffnen ausgewählt haben
• Lebhaft – Ideal für die Wiedergabe bei Tageslicht
• Natürlich – Natürliche Bildeinstellungen
Standard – Die energieeffizienteste
Einstellung – Werksvoreinstellung
• Film – Ideal für die Wiedergabe von Filmen
• Spiel – Ideal für Spiele
• Computer - Ideal für den Anschluss an den
Computer
Bildformat
Bildformat wählen
Wenn das Bild nicht den gesamten Bildschirm
ausfüllt, wenn schwarze Streifen oben oder unten
oder an den Seiten angezeigt werden, können Sie das
Bild so anpassen, dass der Bildschirm vollständig
ausgefüllt wird.
So wählen Sie eine der Basiseinstellungen zum
Ausfüllen des Bildschirms aus:
Drücken Sie Home > Mehr
> Einstellungen > Bildformat.
Die folgenden Formate stehen je nach Bild auf dem
Bildschirm zur Verfügung.
• • Breitbild
• Bildschirm ausfüllen
• Vollbild
• • Nicht skaliert
Toneinstellung
Auswählen einer Einstellung
Drücken Sie Home > Mehr
> Einstellungen > Ton > Toneinstellung.
Zur einfachen Anpassung des Tons können Sie über
"Toneinstellung" eine vordefinierte Einstellung
auswählen.
• Persönlich – Ihre persönliche Auswahl, die Sie unter
"Bild + Ton personalisieren" getroffen haben
27
• Original – Die neutralste Toneinstellung
• Film – Ideal für die Wiedergabe von Filmen
• Musik – Ideal für die Wiedergabe von Musik
• Spiel – Ideal für Spiele
• Nachrichten – Ideal für
Nachrichten/Dokumentationen
Sprache
Ändern der Sprache des TV-Menüs und der
Meldungen
Drücken Sie Home > Mehr > Einstellungen
> Menüsprache.
Wählen Sie Ihre Sprache aus, und drücken Sie OK.
Energiespareinstellungen
Ausschalten des Bildschirms, um Energie zu sparen
Drücken Sie Home > Mehr >
Funktionen > Sleep-Timer > Bild ausgeschaltet.
Wenn Sie auf Ihrem Fernseher nur Musik hören,
können Sie den Fernsehbildschirm ausschalten.
Nur der Fernsehbildschirm wird ausgeschaltet. Um
den Bildschirm wieder einzuschalten, drücken Sie
eine beliebige Taste der Fernbedienung.
Einstellen des Ausschalt-Timers
Drücken Sie Home > Mehr >
Funktionen > Sleep-Timer > Sleep-Timer.
Drücken Sie den Pfeil (nach oben) oder (nach
unten), um den Wert anzupassen. Beim
Wert 0 (Aus) wird das automatische Ausschalten
deaktiviert.
Wenn Sie "Ausschalt-Timer" auswählen, schaltet sich
der Fernseher automatisch aus, um Energie zu
sparen.
* Der Fernseher schaltet sich aus, wenn ein
Fernsehsignal empfangen wird, Sie aber innerhalb
von vier Stunden keine Taste auf der Fernbedienung
drücken.
* Der Fernseher schaltet sich aus, wenn kein
Fernsehsignal empfangen wird und innerhalb von
10 Minuten keine Taste auf der Fernbedienung
gedrückt wird.
* Wenn Sie den Fernseher als Monitor nutzen oder
zum Fernsehen einen Digitalreceiver verwenden (eine
Set-Top-Box, STB) und die Fernbedienung des
Fernsehers nicht zum Einsatz kommt, deaktivieren Sie
das automatische Ausschalten, indem Sie den Wert
auf 0
setzen.
10.10
Google-Konto
Anmelden
Um alle Funktionen Ihres Philips Android TV zu
genießen, können Sie sich mit Ihrem Google-Konto
bei Google anmelden.
Durch die Anmeldung können Sie Ihre Lieblingsspiele
auf dem Telefon, Tablet und Fernseher spielen. Sie
erhalten außerdem auf dem TV-Startbildschirm
maßgeschneiderte Video- und Musikempfehlungen
sowie Zugriff auf YouTube, Google Play und andere
Apps.
Verwenden Sie Ihr bestehendes
Google-Konto, um
sich auf Ihrem Fernseher bei Google anzumelden. Ein
Google-Konto besteht aus einer E-Mail-Adresse und
einem Kennwort. Wenn Sie noch kein Google Konto
haben, verwenden Sie Ihren Computer oder Ihr
Tablet, um eines zu erstellen (accounts.google.com).
Wenn Sie sich bei der Ersteinrichtung des Fernsehers
nicht angemeldet haben, können Sie das jederzeit
später nachholen.
Anmelden
Drücken Sie
> Öffnen Sie den Bildschirm der
Professional-Menü-App.
Wählen Sie oben rechts im Bildschirm der
Professional-Menü-App die Option "Konto
verwalten" aus, und drücken Sie
OK. Geben Sie über
die Bildschirmtastatur Ihre E-Mail-Adresse und Ihr
Passwort ein, und drücken Sie zum Anmelden
dieselbe OK-Taste.
28
11
Android TV-Home-
Bildschirm
11.1
Informationen zum Android
TV-Home-Bildschirm
Um von allen Vorteilen, die Ihr Android-Fernseher
bietet, profitieren zu können, ist eine Verbindung des
Fernsehers mit dem Internet erforderlich.
Wie auf Ihrem Android-Smartphone oder -Tablet ist
der Startbildschirm die Steuerzentrale des Fernsehers.
Über den Startbildschirm können Sie entscheiden,
was Sie sehen möchten, indem Sie
Unterhaltungsmöglichkeiten in der App und im Live-
TV durchsuchen. Ihre Startseite verfügt über Sender,
mit denen Sie tolle Inhalte aus Ihren Lieblings-Apps
entdecken können. Sie können auch weitere Kanäle
hinzufügen oder neue Apps suchen, um noch mehr
Inhalte zu nutzen.
11.2
Öffnen des Android TV-
Home-Bildschirms
Profimodus EIN - siehe Installationshandbuch.
Profimodus AUS - So öffnen Sie den Android TV-
Home-Bildschirm und öffnen ein Element...
1 - Drücken Sie die Taste Menü, navigieren Sie zu
"Philips Collection", und drücken Sie dann OK.
2 - Wählen Sie mit den Pfeiltasten eine Aktivität aus,
und drücken Sie OK, um die Aktivität zu starten.
3 - Um das die Home-Menü ohne Änderung der
aktuellen Aktivität zu schließen, drücken Sie .
Wenn Sie den Android TV-Home-Bildschirm öffnen,
wird die im Hintergrund ausgeführte
Anwendung/Inhaltswiedergabe angehalten. Wählen
Sie zum Fortsetzen die Anwendung bzw. den Inhalt
über den Android TV-Home-Bildschirm aus.
11.3
Android-TV-Einstellungen
Bild
Bildeinstellungen
Bildeinstellung
Auswählen einer Einstellung
Drücken Sie > Einstellungen >
Bild > Bildeinstellung.
Zur einfachen Anpassung des Bildes können Sie eine
vordefinierte Bildeinstellung auswählen.
• Persönlich – Die Bildoptionen, die Sie beim ersten
Öffnen ausgewählt haben
• Lebhaft – Ideal für die Wiedergabe bei Tageslicht
• Natürlich – Natürliche Bildeinstellungen
Standard – Die energieeffizienteste
Einstellung – Werksvoreinstellung
• Film – Ideal für die Wiedergabe von Filmen
• Spiel – Ideal für Spiele
• Computer - Ideal für den Anschluss an den
Computer
Farbe, Kontrast, Schärfe, Helligkeit
Anpassen der Bildfarbe
Drücken Sie Home > Einstellungen >
Bild > Farbe.
Drücken Sie die Pfeiltasten (nach oben)
oder (nach unten), um den Wert der
Farbsättigung des Bilds anzupassen.
Anpassen des Bildkontrasts
Drücken Sie Home > Einstellungen >
Bild > Kontrast. Drücken Sie die Pfeiltasten (nach
oben) oder (nach unten), um den Kontrastwert des
Bilds anzupassen.
Wenn Sie den Kontrastwert verringern, wird weniger
Energie verbraucht.
Anpassen der Bildschärfe
Drücken Sie Home > Einstellungen
> Bild > Schärfe.
Drücken Sie die Pfeiltasten s(nach oben) oder
(nach unten), um den Schärfewert des Bilds
anzupassen.
29
anzupassen.
Helligkeit einstellen
Drücken Sie
Home > Einstellungen
> Bild > Helligkeit.
> Drücken Sie den Pfeil (nach oben) oder (nach
unten), um den Wert für die Helligkeit des Bildsignals
anzupassen.
Hinweis
: Wenn Sie die Helligkeit stark abweichend
vom Referenzwert (50) einstellen, ergibt sich
möglicherweise ein geringerer Kontrast.
Erweiterte Bildeinstellungen
Farbeinstellungen
Erweiterte Farbeinstellungen
Anpassen der Farboptimierung
Drücken Sie Home >
Einstellungen >
Bild > Erweitert > Farbe > Farboptimierung.
Wählen Sie Maximum, Mittel oder Minimum aus,
um die Farbintensität und die Details mit leuchtenden
Farben einzustellen.
Auswählen der voreingestellten Farbtemperatur
Drücken Sie Home > Einstellungen >
Bild > Erweitert > Farbe > Farbtemperatur.
Wählen Sie Normal, Warm oder Kühl aus, um die
Farbtemperatur nach Ihren Vorlieben festzulegen.
Anpassen der Farbtemperatur
Drücken Sie Home > Einstellungen >
Bild > Erweitert > Farbe > Personalisierte
Farbtemperatur.
Wählen Sie im Menü "Farbtemperatur" die Option
"Personalisiert" aus, um selbst eine Farbtemperatur
festzulegen. Drücken Sie den Pfeil (nach oben)
oder (nach unten), um den Wert anzupassen. WP
ist der Weißpunkt, BL ist der Schwarzwert. Sie
können auch eine der Voreinstellungen in diesem
Menü auswählen.
Erweiterte Kontrasteinstellungen
Kontrastmodi
Drücken Sie Home > Einstellungen >
Bild > Erweitert > Kontrast > Kontrastmodus.
Wählen Sie Normal, Optimiert für
Bilder oder Optimiert für Energieeinsparung aus,
um den Fernseher so einzustellen, dass er
automatisch den Kontrast reduziert und so am
wenigsten Energie verbraucht bzw. das beste
Bilderlebnis liefert, oder wählen Sie "Aus", um die
Anpassung auszuschalten.
Dynamic Contrast
Drücken Sie
Home > Einstellungen >
Bild > Erweitert > Kontrast > Dynamischer
Kontrast.
Wählen Sie "Maximum, Mittel oder Minimum aus, um
den Wert festzulegen, bei dem der Fernseher
automatisch Details in dunklen, mittelhellen und
hellen Bereichen des Bildes optimiert.
Videokontrast, Gamma
Videokontrast
Drücken Sie
Home > Einstellungen >
Bild > Erweitert > Kontrast > Videokontrast.
Drücken Sie den Pfeil (nach oben) oder (nach
unten), um den Wert für den Videokontrast
anzupassen.
Gamma
Drücken Sie
Home > Einstellungen >
Bild > Erweitert > Kontrast > Gamma.
Drücken Sie den Pfeil (nach oben) oder (nach
unten), um eine nicht lineare Einstellung für die
Bildhelligkeit und den Kontrast festzulegen.
Verbesserte Schärfeeinstellungen
Ultra Resolution
Drücken SieHome > Einstellungen > Bild >
Erweitert > Schärfe > Ultra Resolution.
Wählen Sie Ein aus, um eine hervorragende Schärfe
bei Linien und Details im Bild zu erhalten.
Scharfe Bilder
Rauschunterdrückung
Drücken Sie
Home >
Einstellungen > Bild >
Erweitert > Scharfe Bilder > Rauschunterdrückung.
Wählen Sie Maximum, Mittel oder Minimum aus, um
den Wert für die Rauschunterdrückung bei
Videoinhalten festzulegen.
Rauschen zeigt sich meist als sich bewegende Punkte
im angezeigten Bild.
30
MPEG-Artefaktunterdrückung
Drücken Sie Home > Einstellungen > Bild >
Erweitert > Scharfe Bilder > MPEG-
Artefaktreduzierung.
Wählen Sie Maximum, Mittel oder Minimum aus,
um die Glättung von Artefakten in digitalen
Videoinhalten entsprechend einzustellen.
MPEG-Artefakte zeigen sich meist als Klötzchen oder
gezackte Ränder in den angezeigten Bildern.
Bildformat
Wenn das Bild nicht den gesamten Bildschirm
ausfüllt, wenn schwarze Streifen oben oder unten
oder an den Seiten angezeigt werden, können Sie das
Bild so anpassen, dass der Bildschirm vollständig
ausgefüllt wird.
So wählen Sie eine der Basiseinstellungen zum
Ausfüllen des Bildschirms aus:
1 - Drücken Sie während der Wiedergabe eines
Fernsehsenders Home > Einstellungen > Bild >
Bildformat.
2 - Wählen Sie aus der Liste ein Format aus, und
drücken Sie die Taste OK.
3 - Drücken Sie gegebenenfalls mehrmals BACK,
um das Menü zu beenden.
Die folgenden Formate stehen je nach Bild auf dem
Bildschirm zur Verfügung. . .
• • Breitbild
• Bildschirm ausfüllen
• Vollbild
• • Nicht skaliert
Ton
Toneinstellung
Auswählen einer Einstellung
Drücken Sie Home > Einstellungen >
Ton > Toneinstellung.
Zur einfachen Anpassung des Tons können Sie über
"Toneinstellung" eine vordefinierte Einstellung
auswählen.
• Persönlich – Ihre persönliche Auswahl, die Sie unter
"Bild + Ton personalisieren" getroffen haben
• Original – Die neutralste Toneinstellung
• Film – Ideal für die Wiedergabe von Filmen
• Musik – Ideal für die Wiedergabe von Musik
• Spiel – Ideal für Spiele
• Nachrichten – Ideal für
Nachrichten/Dokumentationen
Soundmanagement
Wählen Sie ein Gerät.
Drücken Sie Home > Einstellungen >
Ton > Soundmanagement.
Audio-Ausgabegeräte konfigurieren.
• TV-Lautsprecher - Stellen Sie den Fernseher so ein,
dass der Ton über den Fernseher oder das
angeschlossene Audiosystem wiedergegeben wird.
• Kopfhörer-/Badezimmerlautsprecher - Ein/Aus.
• Feste Lautstärke für Kopfhörer/Badezimm.ltspr. - Ist
diese Funktion aktiviert, wird der Lautstärkepegel des
Kopfhörers/Badezimmerlautsprechers auf die
Standardeinstellung fixiert.
• Kopfhörererkennung - Ein/Aus.
Aufstellungsort
Drücken Sie Home > Einstellungen > Ton >
Aufstellungsort.
Wählen Sie Auf Standfuß oder An der Wand aus, um
die optimale Tonwiedergabe entsprechend der
Aufstellungsart zu erhalten.
Erweitert
Energiespareinstellungen
Sleeptimer
Drücken Sie Home > Einstellungen >
Energiespareinstellungen > Sleep-Timer.
Stellen Sie den Fernseher so ein, dass er nach einer
voreingestellten Zeit automatisch in den Standby-
Modus wechselt. Um diese Funktion zu deaktivieren,
stellen Sie die Zeit auf Null.
Drücken Sie den Pfeil (nach oben) oder (nach
unten), um den Wert anzupassen. Beim
Wert 0 (Aus) wird das automatische Ausschalten
deaktiviert.
Wenn Sie "Ausschalt-Timer" auswählen, schaltet sich
der Fernseher automatisch aus, um Energie zu
sparen.
* Der Fernseher schaltet sich aus, wenn ein
Fernsehsignal empfangen wird, Sie aber innerhalb
von vier Stunden keine Taste auf der Fernbedienung
drücken.
* Der Fernseher schaltet sich aus, wenn kein
Fernsehsignal empfangen wird und innerhalb von
10 Minuten keine Taste auf der Fernbedienung
gedrückt wird.
* Wenn Sie den Fernseher als Monitor nutzen oder
zum Fernsehen einen Digitalreceiver verwenden (eine
31
Set-Top-Box, STB) und die Fernbedienung des
Fernsehers nicht zum Einsatz kommt, deaktivieren Sie
das automatische Ausschalten, indem Sie den Wert
auf 0 setzen.
Bild ausgeschaltet
Drücken Sie Home > Einstellungen >
Energiespareinstellungen > Bild ausgeschaltet.
Wenn Sie auf Ihrem Fernseher nur Musik hören,
können Sie den Fernsehbildschirm ausschalten.
Nur der Fernsehbildschirm wird ausgeschaltet. Um
den Bildschirm wieder einzuschalten, drücken Sie
eine beliebige Taste der Fernbedienung.
Region und Sprache
Sprachen
Drücken Sie Home > Einstellungen > Region
und Sprache > Sprachen.
Nehmen Sie Regions- oder Spracheinstellungen vor.
• Androidsystem/Menüsprache - Ändern Sie die
Sprache für Menüs und Meldungen.
• Bevorzugte Audiosprache - Legen Sie die
bevorzugte Einstellung für die Audiosprache in
Sendungen fest.
• Alternative Audiosprache - Legen Sie die nächste
bevorzugte Einstellung für die Audiosprache in
Sendungen fest.
• Bevorzugte Untertitelsprache - Legen Sie die
höchste bevorzugte Einstellung für die
Untertitelsprache in Sendungen fest.
• Alternative Untertitelsprache - Legen Sie die nächste
bevorzugte Einstellung für die Untertitelsprache in
Sendungen fest.
• Bevorzugte Videotextsprache - Legen Sie die erste
bevorzugte Einstellung für die Videotextsprache in
Sendungen fest.
• Alternative Videotextsprache - Legen Sie die
nächste bevorzugte Einstellung für die
Videotextsprache in Sendungen fest.
Einstellungen zu Seh- und Hörhilfen
Drücken Sie > Einstellungen > Seh -und Hör
hilfen> Universalzugriff.
Wenn die Seh- und Hörhilfen aktiviert sind, eignet
sich der Fernseher zur Verwendung durch Personen
mit Seh- und Hörbeeinträchtigungen.
Einschalten der Seh- und Hörhilfen
Drücken Sie > Einstellungen > Seh -und Hör
hilfen > Universalzugriff > Ein.
Seh- und Hörhilfen für hörbehinderte Menschen
Drücken Sie > Einstellungen > Seh - und
Hörhilfen > Universalzugriff > Hörbehindert > Ein.
• Einige digitale Fernsehsender senden ein
besonderes Audiosignal und Untertitel für
hörbehinderte und taube Menschen.
• Wenn Hörhilfen eingeschaltet sind, wechselt der
Fernseher automatisch in den Modus mit
angepasstem Audiosignal und Untertiteln, sofern
verfügbar.
Seh- und Hörhilfen für Menschen mit
Sehbeeinträchtigungen
Drücken Sie > Einstellungen > Seh -und
Hörhilfen > Universalzugriff
> Audiobeschreibung > Audiobeschreibung > Ein.
Digitale Fernsehsender können spezielle
Audiokommentare übertragen, die das Geschehen
auf dem Bildschirm beschreiben.
Einstellungen > Seh- und Hörhilfen > Universal
zugriff > Audiobeschreibung > Kombin. Lautst.,
Soundeffekte, Sprache.
• Wenn Sie Kombin. Lautst. auswählen, können Sie
die Lautstärke des normalen Tons mit den
Audiokommentaren kombinieren. Drücken Sie den
Pfeil (nach oben) or (nach unten), um den
Wert anzupassen.
• Wenn Sie die Soundeffekte einschalten, erhalten Sie
zusätzliche Soundeffekte im Audiokommentar, wie
Stereo oder Ausklingen.
• Wählen Sie Sprache, um die bevorzugte
Spracheinstellung Beschreibend oder Untertitel
auszuwählen.
Sendung themenabh. sperren
Einstufung
Drücken Sie > Einstellungen >
Inhaltseinstufung.>
Inhaltseinstufung.
Damit Kinder keine Sendungen sehen, die für ihr Alter
ungeeignet sind, können Sie eine Altersfreigabe fests
etzen. Digitale Sender haben eine Altersfreigabe in ihr
e Sendungen integriert. Wenn die Freigabe gleich o
der höher als das eingegebene Alter Ihres Kindes
ist, wird die entsprechende Sendung gesperrt. U
m eine gesperrte Sendung wiederzugeben, müss
en Sie zuerst den Code eingeben.
So setzen Sie eine Altersfreigabe fest
Drücken Sie > Einstellungen >
Inhaltseinstufung > Einstufung.
Wählen Sie das Alter, und drücken Sie OK. Um
die Altersfreigabe zu deaktivieren, wählen Sie als
32
Alterseinstellung Keine aus. In einigen Ländern ist es
jedoch vorgeschrieben, eine Altersfreigabe
festzulegen.
Code festlegen und Code ändern
Drücken Sie Home> Einstellungen >
Inhaltseinstufung.
Der Kindersicherungs-Code wird zum Sperren und
Entsperren von Sendern und Sendungen verwendet.
Legen Sie einen neuen Code fest, oder ändern Sie
den Code.
Drücken Sie Home > Einstellungen >
Inhaltseinstufung > Code ändern.
Hinweis:
Wenn Sie Ihren PIN-Code vergessen haben, können
Sie den aktuellen Code durch Eingabe von 8888
umgehen und einen neuen Code eingeben.
11.4
Anschließen Ihres
Android TV
Netzwerk und Internet
Heimnetzwerk
Damit Sie alle Funktionen Ihres Philips Android TV
genießen können, muss Ihr Fernseher mit dem
Internet verbunden sein.
Verbinden Sie den Fernseher mit einer High-Speed-
Internetverbindung mit einem Heimnetzwerk. Sie
können den Fernseher kabellos oder per
Netzwerkkabel mit Ihrem Netzwerkrouter verbinden.
Mit Netzwerk verbinden
Kabellose Verbindung
Was Sie benötigen
Zur kabellosen Verbindung des Fernsehers mit dem
Internet benötigen Sie einen WiFi-Router mit Zugang
zum Internet.
Verwenden Sie einen Router mit einer
Hochgeschwindigkeits-Internetverbindung
(Breitband).
Herstellen der Verbindung
Herstellen der Verbindung – KABELLOS
Drücken Sie Home > Einstellungen
> Kabellos und Netzwerke > Mit Netzwerk
verbinden > KABELLOS.
1 - Wählen Sie in der Liste der gefundenen
Netzwerke Ihr kabelloses Netzwerk aus. Wenn Ihr
Netzwerk nicht in der Liste angezeigt wird, weil der
Netzwerkname ausgeblendet ist (Sie haben die SSID-
Übertragung des Routers deaktiviert), wählen Sie
Neues Netzwerk hinzufügen aus, um den
Netzwerknamen manuell einzugeben.
2 - Geben Sie abhängig vom Routermodell Ihren
Verschlüsselungscode ein (WEP, WPA oder WPA2).
Wenn Sie den Verschlüsselungscode für dieses
Netzwerk bereits eingegeben haben, können Sie
durch Auswahl von OK die Verbindung direkt
herstellen.
3 - Sobald die Verbindung hergestellt wurde, wird
eine Nachricht angezeigt.
Herstellen der Verbindung – WPS
Drücken Sie Home > Einstellungen
> Kabellos und Netzwerke > Mit Netzwerk
verbinden > WPS.
Wenn Ihr Router WPS unterstützt, können Sie ohne
Netzwerksuche direkt eine Verbindung zum Router
herstellen. Wenn Geräte in Ihrem WLAN-Netzwerk
das WEP-Verschlüsselungssystem verwenden, ist die
Verwendung von WPS nicht möglich.
1 - Gehen Sie zum Router, drücken Sie die WPS-
Taste, und kehren Sie innerhalb von 2 Minuten zum
Fernseher zurück.
2 - Wählen Sie zum Herstellen der Verbindung
Verbinden.
3 - Sobald die Verbindung hergestellt wurde, wird
eine Nachricht angezeigt.
Herstellen der Verbindung – WPS MIT PIN-Code
Drücken Sie Home > Einstellungen
> Kabellos und Netzwerke > Mit Netzwerk
verbinden > WPS MIT PIN-Code.
33
Wenn Ihr Router WPS mit PIN-Code unterstützt,
können Sie ohne Netzwerksuche direkt eine
Verbindung zum Router herstellen. Wenn Geräte in
Ihrem WLAN-Netzwerk das WEP-
Verschlüsselungssystem verwenden, ist die
Verwendung von WPS nicht möglich.
1 - Notieren Sie sich den achtstelligen PIN-Code, der
auf dem Bildschirm angezeigt wird, und geben Sie ihn
in der Router-Software auf Ihrem PC ein. Im
Handbuch zu Ihrem Router erfahren Sie, wo Sie den
PIN-Code in der Router-Software eingeben müssen.
2 - Wählen Sie zum Herstellen der Verbindung
Verbinden.
3 - Sobald die Verbindung hergestellt wurde, wird
eine Nachricht angezeigt.
Probleme
Kabelloses Netzwerk wurde nicht gefunden oder ist
gestört
• Mikrowellenherde, DECT-Telefone oder andere
Geräte mit WiFi 802.11b/g/n/ac in der Nähe können
möglicherweise Störungen im WLAN-Netzwerk
verursachen.
• Stellen Sie sicher, dass Sie über die Firewalls im
Netzwerk Zugriff auf die kabellose Verbindung mit
dem Fernseher erlauben.
• Wenn das kabellose Netzwerk nicht ordnungsgemäß
funktioniert, testen Sie die kabelgebundene
Netzwerkinstallation.
Das Internet funktioniert nicht
• Prüfen Sie, falls die Verbindung zum Router
ordnungsgemäß funktioniert, die Verbindung des
Routers mit dem Internet.
Der PC und die Internetverbindung sind langsam
• Informieren Sie sich in der Bedienungsanleitung des
kabellosen Routers über die Reichweite in
Innenräumen, die Übertragungsrate und über die
anderen Faktoren zur Signalqualität.
• Sie benötigen für den Router eine
Hochgeschwindigkeitsverbindung (Breitband) zum
Internet.
DHCP
• Wenn keine Verbindung hergestellt werden kann,
überprüfen Sie die DHCP-Einstellung (Dynamic Host
Configuration Protocol) des Routers. DHCP sollte
aktiviert sein.
Kabelgebundene Verbindung
Was Sie benötigen
Zur Verbindung des Fernsehers mit dem Internet
benötigen Sie einen Router mit Zugang zum
Internet. Verwenden Sie einen Router mit einer
Hochgeschwindigkeits-Internetverbindung
(Breitband).
Herstellen der Verbindung
Herstellen der Verbindung – KABELGEBUNDEN
Drücken Sie Home > Einstellungen
> Kabellos und Netzwerke > Mit Netzwerk
verbinden > KABELGEBUNDEN.
1 - Verbinden Sie den Router über ein Netzwerkkabel
(Ethernet-Kabel**) mit dem Fernseher.
2 - Prüfen Sie, ob der Router tatsächlich
eingeschaltet ist.
3 - Der Fernseher sucht kontinuierlich nach der
Netzwerkverbindung.
4 - Sobald die Verbindung hergestellt wurde, wird
eine Nachricht angezeigt.
Wenn keine Verbindung hergestellt werden kann,
überprüfen Sie die DHCP-Einstellung des Routers.
DHCP sollte aktiviert sein.
**Verwenden Sie ein abgeschirmtes FTP-Cat. 5E-
Ethernetkabel, um den EMC-Anforderungen zu
entsprechen.
Einstellungen
Netzwerkeinstellungen anzeigen
Drücken Sie Home > Einstellungen
> Kabellos und Netzwerke > Einstellungen
> Netzwerkeinstellungen anzeigen.
Sie können alle aktuellen Netzwerkeinstellungen hier
anzeigen. Die IP- und MAC-Adresse, die Signalstärke,
die Geschwindigkeit, die Verschlüsselungsmethode
usw.
Netzwerkkonfiguration – DHCP / statische IP-
Adresse
Drücken Sie Home > Einstellungen
> Kabellos und Netzwerke > Einstellungen
> Netzwerkkonfiguration > DHCP / statische IP.
Wählen Sie DHCP aus. Fortgeschrittene Benutzer
können ihr Netzwerk auch mit einer statischen IP-
Adresse einrichten.
Netzwerkkonfiguration – Statische IP-Konfiguration
34
Drücken Sie Home > Einstellungen
> Kabellos und Netzwerke > Einstellungen
> Statische IP-Konfiguration.
1 - Wählen Sie Statische IP-Konfiguration, und
konfigurieren Sie die Verbindung.
2 - Sie können die Werte für IP-
Adresse, Netzmaske, Gateway, DNS 1
oder DNS 2 einstellen.
Wake on LAN (WoL)
Drücken Sie Home > Einstellungen
> Kabellos und Netzwerke > Einstellungen >
Wake on LAN (WoL).
Wake on LAN (WoL) (de-)aktivieren. Sie können den
Fernseher mit einem externen Gerät über das gleiche
LAN aktivieren.
Wake on Wi-Fi (WoWLAN)
Drücken Sie Home > Einstellungen
> Kabellos und Netzwerke > Einstellungen >
Wake on Wi-Fi (WoWLAN).
Wake on WiFi (WoWLAN) (de-)aktivieren. Sie können
den Fernseher mit einem externen Gerät über das
gleiche WiFi aktivieren.
Netzwerktyp
Drücken Sie Home > Einstellungen
> Kabellos und Netzwerke > Einstellungen >
Netzwerktyp.
• Kabelgebunden - Verbindung mit einem
kabelgebundenen Netzwerk.
• Kabellos - Wählen Sie in der Liste der gefundenen
Netzwerke Ihr kabelloses Netzwerk aus. Wenn Ihr
Netzwerk nicht in der Liste angezeigt wird, weil der
Netzwerkname ausgeblendet ist (Sie haben die SSID-
Übertragung des Routers deaktiviert), wählen Sie
Neues Netzwerk hinzufügen aus, um den
Netzwerknamen manuell einzugeben.
• WPS - Wenn Ihr Router WPS unterstützt, können Sie
ohne Netzwerksuche direkt eine Verbindung zum
Router herstellen. Wenn Geräte in Ihrem WLAN-
Netzwerk das WEP-Verschlüsselungssystem
verwenden, ist die Verwendung von WPS nicht
möglich.
• WPS mit PIN-Code - Wenn Ihr Router WPS mit PIN-
Code unterstützt, können Sie ohne Netzwerksuche
direkt eine Verbindung zum Router herstellen. Wenn
Geräte in Ihrem WLAN-Netzwerk das WEP-
Verschlüsselungssystem verwenden, ist die
Verwendung von WPS nicht möglich.
Google-Konto
Anmelden
Um alle Funktionen Ihres Philips Android TV zu
genießen, können Sie sich mit Ihrem Google-Konto
bei Google anmelden.
Durch die Anmeldung können Sie Ihre Lieblingsspiele
auf dem Telefon, Tablet und Fernseher spielen. Sie
erhalten außerdem auf dem TV-Startbildschirm
maßgeschneiderte Video- und Musikempfehlungen
sowie Zugriff auf YouTube, Google Play und andere
Apps.
Verwenden Sie Ihr bestehendes Google-Konto, um
sich auf Ihrem Fernseher bei Google anzumelden. Ein
Google-Konto besteht aus einer E-Mail-Adresse und
einem Kennwort. Wenn Sie noch kein Google Konto
haben, verwenden Sie Ihren Computer oder Ihr
Tablet, um eines zu erstellen (accounts.google.com).
Um Spiele mit Google Play zu spielen, benötigen Sie
ein Google+-Profil. Wenn Sie sich bei der
Ersteinrichtung des Fernsehers nicht angemeldet
haben, können Sie das jederzeit später nachholen.
Anmelden
Drücken Sie Home > Apps > Google Play.
Geben Sie über die Bildschirmtastatur Ihre E-Mail-
Adresse und Ihr Passwort ein, und drücken Sie zum
Anmelden dieselbe OK-Taste.
Android-Einstellungen
Sie können verschiedene Android-spezifische
Einstellungen oder Informationen einstellen bzw.
anzeigen. Sie können die Liste mit Apps aufrufen, die
auf Ihrem Fernseher installiert sind, und prüfen, wie
viel Speicherplatz diese einnehmen. Sie können die
Sprache einstellen, die Sie für die Sprachsuche
verwenden möchten. Sie können die
Bildschirmtastatur konfigurieren oder Apps erlauben,
Ihren Standort zu verwenden. Erkunden Sie die
verschiedenen Android-Einstellungen. Besuchen
Sie www.support.google.com/androidtv, um weitere
Informationen zu diesen Einstellungen zu erhalten.
So öffnen Sie diese Einstellungen
Drücken Sie Home > Einstellungen >
Einstellungen > Android-Einstellungen.
35
11.5
Programme
Senderlisten
Informationen zu Senderlisten
Nach der Senderinstallation werden alle Sender in der
Senderliste angezeigt. Sender werden mit Name und
Logo angezeigt, sofern diese Informationen verfügbar
sind.
Wenn eine Senderliste ausgewählt ist, können Sie mit
den Pfeiltasten (nach oben) oder (nach unten)
einen Sender auswählen. Drücken Sie dann OK, um
den ausgewählten Sender anzusehen. Sie können mit
den Tasten   oder   nur die in dieser Liste
enthaltenen Sender einschalten.
Radiosender
Wenn digitale Sendungen verfügbar sind, werden
während der Installation auch digitale Radiosender
installiert. Sie können wie bei Fernsehprogrammen
zwischen Radiosendern wechseln.
Öffnen einer Senderliste
So öffnen Sie die aktuelle Senderliste:
1. Drücken Sie , um zum Fernsehen zu wechseln.
2. Drücken Sie , um die aktuelle Senderliste zu
öffnen.
Drücken Sie erneut, um die Senderliste zu
schließen.
Anzeigen von Sendern
Einschalten eines Senders
Um Fernsehsender anzuzeigen, drücken Sie . Der
Fernseher schaltet automatisch auf den Sender, den
Sie zuletzt gesehen haben.
Umschalten der Sender
- Um zwischen den Sendern umzuschalten, drücken
Sie oder
Vorheriger Sender
Wenn Sie zurück zum zuvor wiedergegebenen Sender
wechseln möchten, drücken Sie BACK.
Senderliste
Drücken Sie beim Fernsehen die Taste , um die
Senderliste zu öffnen.
Senderoptionen
Öffnen der Optionen
Common Interface
Wenn Sie ein CAM in einem der Common Interface-
Steckplätze installiert haben, können Sie CAM- und
Betreiberinformationen anzeigen oder bestimmte
CAM-bezogene Einstellungen vornehmen.
So zeigen Sie die CAM-Informationen an:
1 - Stellen Sie den Sender ein, und drücken
Sie OPTIONS.
2 - Wählen Sie Common Interface aus.
3 - Wählen Sie den jeweiligen Common Interface-
Steckplatz aus, und drücken Sie (rechts).
4 - Wählen Sie den Fernsehbetreiber des CAM aus,
und drücken Sie OK. Die folgenden Bildschirme
stammen vom Fernsehbetreiber.
Untertitel
Untertitelsprache
Bevorzugte Untertitelsprachen
Digitale Übertragungen können für eine Sendung
mehrere Untertitelsprachen anbieten. Sie können eine
bevorzugte und eine alternative Untertitelsprache
auswählen. Wenn Untertitel in einer dieser Sprachen
zur Verfügung stehen, werden sie vom Fernseher
angezeigt.
So legen Sie die bevorzugte und die alternative
Untertitelsprache fest:
1 - Drücken Sie Home. Drücken Sie (nach
unten), wählen Sie Einstellungen und drücken
Sie OK.
2 - Wählen Sie Region und
Sprache > Sprachen > Bevorzugte
Untertitelsprache oder Alternative Untertitelsprache
aus.
3 - Wählen Sie die gewünschte Sprache aus, und
drücken Sie OK.
4 - Drücken Sie (links), um einen Schritt
zurückzugehen, oder drücken Sie BACK, um das
Menü zu schließen.
Auswählen einer Untertitelsprache
Wenn keine der bevorzugten Untertitelsprachen
verfügbar sind, können Sie eine andere
Untertitelsprache auswählen, sofern verfügbar. Wenn
keine Untertitelsprachen verfügbar sind, steht diese
Option nicht zur Auswahl zur Verfügung.
So stellen Sie eine Untertitelsprache ein, wenn keine
36
Ihrer ausgewählten Sprachen verfügbar ist:
1 - Drücken Sie OPTIONS.
2 - Wählen Sie Untertitelsprache und dann eine der
Sprachen als Untertitelsprache aus, die
vorübergehend verwendet werden soll.
Audiosprache
Bevorzugte Audiosprache
Digitale Übertragungen können für eine Sendung
mehrere Audiosprachen (gesprochene Sprachen)
anbieten. Sie können eine bevorzugte und eine
alternative Audiosprache auswählen. Wenn der Ton in
einer dieser Sprachen zur Verfügung steht, wird die
Audiosprache automatisch vom Fernseher
ausgewählt.
So legen Sie die bevorzugte und die alternative
Audiosprache fest:
1 - Drücken Sie Home. Drücken Sie (nach
unten), wählen Sie Einstellungen und drücken
Sie OK.
2 - Wählen Sie Region und Sprache und
dann Sprachen > Bevorzugte
Audiosprache oder Alternative Audiosprache aus.
3 - Wählen Sie die gewünschte Sprache aus, und
drücken Sie OK.
4 - Drücken Sie (links), um einen Schritt
zurückzugehen, oder drücken Sie BACK, um das
Menü zu schließen.
Auswählen einer Audiosprache
Wenn keine der bevorzugten Audiosprachen
verfügbar ist, können Sie eine andere Audiosprache
auswählen, sofern verfügbar. Wenn keine
Audiosprachen verfügbar sind, steht diese Option
nicht zur Auswahl zur Verfügung.
So stellen Sie eine Audiosprache ein, wenn keine Ihrer
bevorzugten Sprachen verfügbar ist:
1 - Drücken Sie OPTIONS.
2 - Wählen Sie Audiosprache und dann die
Audiosprache, die vorübergehend verwendet werden
soll.
Senderinformationen
Senderdetails anzeigen
So rufen Sie Informationen zum ausgewählten Sender
auf...
1 - Schalten Sie den Sender ein.
2 - Drücken Sie OPTIONS, wählen
Sie Senderinformationen aus, und drücken Sie OK.
3 - Um diesen Bildschirm zu schließen, drücken
Sie OK.
Mono/Stereo
Sie können für den Ton eines analogen Senders
Mono bzw. Stereo auswählen.
So wechseln Sie zu Mono bzw. Stereo:
1 - Schalten Sie einen analogen Sender ein.
2 - Drücken Sie OPTIONS, wählen
Sie Mono/Stereo aus, und drücken Sie (nach
rechts).
3 - Wählen Sie Mono oder Stereo aus, und drücken
Sie OK.
4 - Drücken Sie (links), um einen Schritt
zurückzugehen, oder drücken Sie BACK, um das
Menü zu schließen.
Programminformationen
Anzeigen von Informationen zur Sendung
So rufen Sie Informationen zur ausgewählten
Sendung auf:
1 - Schalten Sie den Sender ein.
2 - Drücken Sie OPTIONS, wählen
Sie Programminformationen aus, und drücken
Sie OK.
3 - Um diesen Bildschirm zu schließen, drücken
Sie OK.
11.6
Einstellung der Sender
Installieren von Sendern
Antennen-/Kabelinstallation
Sendersuche
Sie können alle Sender neu installieren und alle
anderen Fernsehereinstellungen beibehalten.
Wenn ein PIN-Code festgelegt wurde, müssen Sie
diesen Code vor dem erneuten Einstellen der Sender
eingeben.
So suchen Sie nach Sendern...
1 - Drücken Sie Home > Einstellungen >
Sender installieren, und drücken Sie OK.
2 - Wählen Sie RF Senderinstallation aus, und
drücken Sie OK.
3 - Geben Sie Ihren PIN-Code ein, falls erforderlich.
Wählen Sie Nach Sendern suchen aus, und drücken
Sie OK.
37
Wählen Sie Start aus, und drücken Sie OK.Wählen Sie das Land aus, in dem Sie sich gerade
befinden, und drücken Sie OK.
Wählen Sie Start aus, und drücken Sie OK.
Wählen Sie die gewünschte Installationsart aus,
Antenne (DVB-T) oder Kabel (DVB-C), und drücken
Sie OK.
Wählen Sie Weiter aus, und drücken Sie OK.
Wählen Sie die gewünschte Senderart aus, Digitale
und analoge Sender oder Nur digitale Sender, und
drücken Sie OK.
Wählen Sie Weiter aus, und drücken Sie OK.
Wählen Sie Start aus, und drücken Sie OK, um die
digitalen Sender zu aktualisieren. Dies kann einige
Minuten in Anspruch nehmen.
Drücken Sie (links), um einen Schritt
zurückzugehen, oder drücken Sie BACK, um das
Menü zu schließen.
Autom.Senderaktualisierung
Wenn Sie digitale Sender empfangen, können Sie den
Fernseher so einstellen, dass diese Sender
automatisch aktualisiert werden.
Täglich um 6 Uhr morgens aktualisiert der Fernseher
die Sender und speichert neu hinzugekommene
Sender. Neue Sender werden in der Senderliste
gespeichert und mit einem gekennzeichnet.
Sender ohne Signal werden entfernt. Der Fernseher
muss sich im Standby-Modus befinden, um Sender
automatisch zu aktualisieren. Sie können die
automatische Senderaktualisierung jedoch auch
deaktivieren.
So deaktivieren Sie die automatische Aktualisierung:
1 - Drücken Sie Home > Einstellungen >
Sender installieren und drücken Sie dann OK.
2 - Wählen Sie RF Senderinstallation aus, und
drücken Sie OK.
3 - Geben Sie Ihren PIN-Code ein, falls erforderlich.
4 - Wählen Sie Autom. Senderaktualisierung aus,
und drücken Sie OK.
5 - Legen Sie Aus fest, und drücken Sie OK.
6 - Drücken Sie (links), um einen Schritt
zurückzugehen, oder drücken Sie BACK, um das
Menü zu schließen.
Senderaktualisierungsnachricht
Wenn neue Sender gefunden oder vorhandene
Sender aktualisiert oder entfernt werden, wird beim
Einschalten des Fernsehers eine Nachricht
eingeblendet. Wenn diese Nachricht nicht nach jeder
Senderaktualisierung angezeigt werden soll, können
Sie sie deaktivieren.
So deaktivieren Sie die Nachricht:
1 - Drücken Sie Home > Einstellungen >
Sender installieren und drücken Sie dann OK.
2 - Wählen Sie RF Senderinstallation aus, und
drücken Sie OK.
3 - Geben Sie Ihren PIN-Code ein, falls erforderlich.
4 - Wählen Sie Autom. Senderaktualisierung aus,
und drücken Sie OK.
5 - Legen Sie Aus fest, und drücken Sie OK.
6 - Drücken Sie (links), um einen Schritt
zurückzugehen, oder drücken Sie BACK, um das
Menü zu schließen.
In einigen Ländern erfolgt die automatische
Senderaktualisierung während der
Programmwiedergabe oder wenn sich der Fernseher
im Standby-Modus befindet.
Digital: Manuelle Installation
Digitale Fernsehsender können nacheinander
manuell installiert werden.
So installieren Sie digitale Sender manuell:
1 - Drücken Sie Home > Einstellungen >
Sender installieren und drücken Sie dann OK.
2 - Wählen Sie RF Senderinstallation aus, und
drücken Sie OK.
3 - Wählen SieDigital: Manuelle Installation aus,
und drücken Sie OK.
4 - Wählen Sie Suchen aus, und drücken Sie OK. Sie
können selbst eine Frequenz eingeben, um einen
Sender zu suchen, oder Sie lassen den Fernseher
nach einem Sender suchen. Drücken Sie (rechts),
um Suchen auszuwählen, und drücken Sie OK, um
automatisch nach einem Sender zu suchen. Der
gefundene Sender wird auf dem Bildschirm angezeigt.
Wenn der Empfang schlecht ist, drücken Sie
erneut Suchen. Wenn Sie den Sender speichern
möchten, wählen Sie Fertig aus, und drücken
Sie OK.
Analog: Manuelle Installation
Analoge Fernsehsender können nacheinander
manuell eingestellt werden.
So installieren Sie analoge Sender manuell:
1 - Drücken Sie Home > Einstellungen >
Sender installieren und drücken Sie dann OK.
2 - Wählen Sie RF Senderinstallation aus, und
drücken Sie OK.
3 - Wählen Sie Analog: Manuelle Installation aus,
und drücken Sie OK.
System
Um das Fernsehsystem einzurichten, wählen
Sie System aus.
Wählen Sie Ihr Land oder das Gebiet aus, in dem Sie
sich derzeit befinden, und drücken Sie OK.
Sender suchen
Um einen Sender zu suchen, wählen Sie Sender
38
suchen aus, und drücken Sie OK. Sie können selbst
eine Frequenz eingeben, um einen Sender zu suchen,
oder Sie lassen den Fernseher nach einem Sender
suchen. Drücken Sie (rechts),
um Suchen auszuwählen, und drücken Sie OK, um
automatisch nach einem Sender zu suchen. Der
gefundene Sender wird auf dem Bildschirm angezeigt.
Wenn der Empfang schlecht ist, drücken Sie
erneut Suchen. Wenn Sie den Sender speichern
möchten, wählen Sie Fertig aus, und drücken
Sie OK.
Speichern
Sie können den Sender unter der aktuellen
Sendernummer oder mit einer neuen Sendernummer
speichern.
Wählen Sie Aktuellen Sender speichern oder Als
neuen Sender speichern aus, und drücken Sie OK.
Die neue Sendernummer wird kurz angezeigt.
Sie können diese Schritte wiederholen, bis alle
verfügbaren analogen Fernsehsender eingestellt sind.
11.7
Internet
Starten des Internets
Sie können auf Ihrem Fernseher im Internet
surfen. Prinzipiell können Sie jede beliebige Internet-
Website aufrufen, die meisten sind jedoch nicht auf
das Bildschirmformat zugeschnitten.
• Einige Plug-ins (z. B. zur Anzeige von Seiten oder
Videos) sind auf dem Fernseher nicht verfügbar.
• Sie können keine Dateien senden oder
herunterladen.
• Internet-Seiten werden seitenweise und als Vollbild
angezeigt.
So starten Sie den Internet-Browser:
1 - Drücken Sie HOME.
2 - Blättern Sie nach unten, wählen
Sie Apps > Internet , und drücken Sie OK.
3 - Geben Sie eine Internetadresse ein, wählen Sie
aus, und drücken Sie OK.
4 - Um das Internet zu schließen, drücken Sie
HOME oder .
Optionen im Internet
Es stehen einige Extras für das Internet zur Verfügung.
So öffnen Sie die Extras:
1 - Drücken Sie bei geöffneter Website OPTIONS.
2 - Wählen Sie eines der Elemente aus, und drücken
Sie OK.
• Add to Speed Dial (Zur Kurzwahl hinzufügen): Zum
Eingeben einer neuen Adresse im Internetadresse.
• Add to Bookmarks (Zu Lesezeichen hinzufügen):
Zum Hinzufügen der Seite als Lesezeichen
• Page Security (Seitensicherheit): Zum Anzeigen der
Sicherheitsstufe der aktuellen Seite.
• New Private Tab (Neue private Registerkarte):
Öffnen einer neuen privaten Registerkarte für privates
Surfen
• Einstellungen: Einstellungen für
Vergrößern/Verkleinern, Textgröße, Seh -und
Hörhilfen, Menüleiste immer anzeigen und (Browser-)
Verlauf löschen
• Hilfe: Informationen zum Internet-Browser
• Exit Internet Browser (Internet-Browser schließen):
Internet-Browser schließen
11.8
Smartphones und Tablets
MHL
Dieser Fernseher ist MHL™-konform.
Wenn Ihr Mobilgerät ebenfalls MHL-konform ist,
können Sie es über ein MHL-Kabel mit dem
Fernseher verbinden. Wenn das MHL-Kabel
verbunden ist, können Sie Inhalte von Ihrem
Mobilgerät auf dem Fernseher wiedergeben. Das
Mobilgerät lädt gleichzeitig den Akku auf. Die MHL-
Verbindung ist ideal zum längeren Ansehen von
Filmen oder Spielen von Spielen von Ihrem
Mobilgerät auf dem Fernseher.
Laden
Wenn das MHL-Kabel angeschlossen ist, wird das
Gerät geladen, wenn der Fernseher eingeschaltet ist
(nicht im Standby-Modus).
MHL-Kabel
Sie benötigen ein passives MHL-Kabel (HDMI zu
Micro USB), um Ihr Mobilgerät mit dem Fernseher zu
verbinden. Sie benötigen möglicherweise einen
zusätzlichen Adapter für den Anschluss mit Ihrem
Mobilgerät, um das MHL-Kabels mithilfe der
HDMI 1-MHL -Verbindung an den Fernseher
anzuschließen.
MHL, Mobile High-Definition Link und das MHL-Logo
sind Marken oder eingetragene Marken der MHL, LLC.
39
11.9
Software
Software aktualisieren
Softwareversion
So zeigen Sie die aktuelle Version der
Fernsehersoftware an:
1 - Drücken Sie , wählen Sie Einstellungen ,
und drücken Sie OK.
2 - Wählen Sie Software aktualisieren > Momentane
Firmware, und drücken Sie OK.
3 - Die Version, Versionshinweise und das
Erstelldatum werden angezeigt.
4 - Drücken Sie gegebenenfalls mehrmals (links),
um das Menü zu schließen.
Update von der Website
Die aktuelle Firmware-Version Ihres Fernsehers
finden Sie im Einstellungsmenü unter "Software
aktualisieren" > "Momentane Firmware".
Besuchen Sie regelmäßig www.philips.com/support,
um neue Firmware-Updates zu erhalten.
Befolgen Sie die nachstehenden Anweisungen, um
die Firmware Ihres Fernsehers zu aktualisieren.
Herunterladen der neuesten Software...
1 - Starten Sie den Internet Explorer.
2 - Rufen Sie die Philips Support-Website unter
http://www.philips.com/support auf.
3 - Geben Sie die Modellnummer ein. (Die
Modellnummer finden Sie auf dem Etikett auf der
Rückseite des Fernsehers. )
4 - Rufen Sie die Produktseite Ihres Fernsehers und
dort Support auf.
5 - Wählen Sie "Software-Aktualisierungen" aus, und
klicken Sie auf "Datei herunterladen", um die Software
herunterzuladen. (Die Software ist als ZIP-Datei
verfügbar.)
6 - Wenn die Softwareversion höher ist als die auf
Ihrem Fernseher installierte Version, klicken Sie auf
den Link zum Herunterladen der Software.
7 - Akzeptieren Sie die
Lizenzvereinbarung/Geschäftsbedingungen, wählen
Sie "Ich stimme zu", und die ZIP-Datei wird
automatisch heruntergeladen.
8 - Entpacken Sie die Zip-Datei mit einem
Archivierungstool in einem beliebigen Verzeichnis.
9 - Erstellen Sie den Ordner "Upgrades" im
Stammverzeichnis Ihres USB-Flashlaufwerks.
10 - Kopieren Sie die zuvor extrahierte upg-Datei in
den erstellten Ordner "Upgrades" (wie auf der
Abbildung unten dargestellt).
11 - Trennen Sie Ihr USB-Flash-Laufwerk vom
Computer.
Software aktualisieren...
1 - Schließen Sie das USB-Flashlaufwerk (mit der
Software-Aktualisierung) an den USB-Anschluss des
Fernsehers an. Warten Sie 30 Sekunden (ggf. auch
länger), bis der Fernseher das USB-Laufwerk erkennt.
2 - Der Fernseher lädt die Software automatisch.
3 - Nachdem der Fernseher die Software geladen
hat, drücken Sie "Start", um das Upgrade zu aktivieren.
40
12
Open-Source-
Software
12.1
Open-Source-Lizenz
Informationen zur Open-Source-
Lizenz
README für den Quellcode der Teile der
Fernsehersoftware von TP Vision Netherlands B.V.,
die unter Open-Source-Lizenzen fallen.
In diesem Dokument wird die Verteilung des
Quellcodes beschrieben, der im TP Vision
Netherlands B.V.-Fernseher verwendet wird. Für
diese Quellcodes gilt entweder die GNU General
Public License (die GPL) oder die GNU Lesser General
Public License (die LGPL) oder eine weitere Open
Source-Lizenz. Anweisungen zum Erhalt von Kopien
dieser Software finden Sie in der
Bedienungsanleitung.
TP Vision Netherlands B.V. LEHNT DIE GEWÄHRUNG
SÄMTLICHER AUSDRÜCKLICHER ODER
STILLSCHWEIGENDER GARANTIEN JEGLICHER ART
AB, AUCH GARANTIEN DER MARKTFÄHIGKEIT ODER
DER EIGNUNG FÜR EINEN BESTIMMTEN ZWECK IN
BEZUG AUF DIESE SOFTWARE. TP Vision
Netherlands B.V. bietet keinen Support für diese
Software. Die vorangegangenen Informationen haben
keinerlei Auswirkungen auf Ihre Garantien und
rechtlichen Ansprüche bezüglich der von Ihnen
erworbenen TP Vision Netherlands B.V.-Produkte.
Dies gilt nur für den für Sie zugänglich gemachten
Quellcode.
Open Source
Android (7.1.1)
This tv contains the Android Nougat Software.
Android is a Linux-based operating system designed
primarily for touchscreen mobile devices such as
smartphones and tablet computers. This software will
also be reused in TPVision Android based TV's. The
original download site for this software is
: https://android.googlesource.com/
. This piece of
software is made available under the terms and
conditions of the Apache license version 2, which can
be found below. Android APACHE License Version 2
( http://source.android.com/source/licenses.html ).
This includes all external sources used by official
Android AOSP.
linux kernel (3.10.79)
This tv contains the Linux Kernel. The original
download site for this software is
: http://www.kernel.org/ . This piece of software is
made available under the terms and conditions of the
GPL v2 license, which can be found below.
Additionally, following exception applies: "NOTE! This
copyright does *not* cover user programs that use
kernel services by normal system calls - this is merely
considered normal use of the kernel, and does *not*
fall under the heading of "derived work". Also note
that the GPL below is copyrighted by the Free
Software Foundation, but the instance of code that it
refers to (the linux kernel) is copyrighted by me and
others who actually wrote it. Also note that the only
valid version of the GPL as far as the kernel is
concerned is _this_ particular version of the license (ie
v2, not v2.2 or v3.x or whatever), unless explicitly
otherwise stated. Linus Torvalds"
libcurl (7.50.1)
libcurl is a free and easy-to-use client-side URL
transfer library, supporting DICT, FILE, FTP, FTPS,
Gopher, HTTP, HTTPS, IMAP, IMAPS, LDAP, LDAPS,
POP3, POP3S, RTMP, RTSP, SCP, SFTP, SMTP,
SMTPS, Telnet and TFTP. libcurl supports SSL
certificates, HTTP POST, HTTP PUT, FTP uploading,
HTTP form based upload, proxies, cookies,
user+password authentication (Basic, Digest, NTLM,
Negotiate, Kerberos), file transfer resume, http proxy
tunneling and more! The original download site for
this software is
: http://curl.haxx.se/libcurl/ COPYRIGHT AND
PERMISSION NOTICE Copyright (c) 1996 - 2010,
Daniel Stenberg, daniel@haxx.se. All rights reserved.
Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this
software for any purpose with or without fee is
hereby granted, provided that the above copyright
notice and this permission notice appear in all copies.
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT
WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS ORIMPLIED,
INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES
OF MERCHANTABILITY,FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT OF THIRD
PARTY RIGHTS. INNO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS
OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY
CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER
IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OROTHERWISE,
ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH
THE SOFTWARE OR THE USEOR OTHER DEALINGS
IN THE SOFTWARE. Except as contained in this
notice, the name of a copyright holder shall not be
used in advertising or otherwise to promote the sale,
use or other dealings in this Software without prior
written authorization of the copyright holder.
41
libfreetypeex (2.4.2)
FreeType is a software development library, available
in source and binary forms, used to render text on to
bitmaps and provides support for other font-related
operations. The original download site for this
software is
: https://github.com/julienr/libfreetype-android
Freetype License
libjpegex (8a)
This package contains C software to implement JPEG
image encoding, decoding, and transcoding. This
software is based in part on the work of the
Independent JPEG Group.----------------------The
authors make NO WARRANTY or representation,
either express or implied, with respect to this
software, its quality, accuracy, merchantability, or
fitness for a particular purpose. This software is
provided "AS IS", and you, its user, assume the entire
risk as to its quality and accuracy. This software is
copyright (C) 1991-1998, Thomas G. Lane. All Rights
Reserved except as specified below. Permission is
hereby granted to use, copy, modify, and distribute
this software (or portions thereof) for any purpose,
without fee, subject to these conditions:(1) If any part
of the source code for this software is distributed,
then this README file must be included, with this
copyright and no-warranty notice unaltered; and any
additions, deletions, or changes to the original files
must be clearly indicated in accompanying
documentation.(2) If only executable code is
distributed, then the accompanying documentation
must state that "this software is based in part on the
work of the Independent JPEG Group".(3) Permission
for use of this software is granted only if the user
accepts full responsibility for any undesirable
consequences; the authors accept NO LIABILITY for
damages of any kind. These conditions apply to any
software derived from or based on the IJG code, not
just to the unmodified library. If you use our work, you
ought to acknowledge us. Permission is NOT granted
for the use of any IJG author's name or company
name in advertising or publicity relating to this
software or products derived from it. This software
may be referred to only as "the Independent JPEG
Group's software". We specifically permit and
encourage the use of this software as the basis of
commercial products, provided that all warranty or
liability claims are assumed by the product vendor.
libpngex (1.4.1)
libpng is the official Portable Network Graphics (PNG)
reference library (originally called pnglib). It is a
platform-independent library that contains C
functions for handling PNG images. It supports almost
all of PNG's features, is extensible. The original
download site for this software is :
https://github.com/julienr/libpng-androidlibpng
license
dvbsnoop (1.2)
dvbsnoop is a DVB / MPEG stream analyzer program.
For generating CRC32 values required for composing
PAT, PMT, EIT sections The original download site for
this software is :
https://github.com/a4tunado/dvbsnoop/blob/master
/src/misc/crc32.cGPL v2
http://dvbsnoop.sourceforge.net/dvbsnoop.html
gSoap (2.7.15)
The gSOAP toolkit is an open source C and C++
software development toolkit for SOAP/XML Web
services and generic (non-SOAP) C/C++ XML data
bindings. Part of the software embedded in this
product is gSOAP software. Portions created by
gSOAP are Copyright 2001-2009 Robert A. van
Engelen, Genivia inc. All Rights Reserved. THE
SOFTWARE IN THIS PRODUCT WAS IN PART
PROVIDED BY GENIVIA INC AND ANY EXPRESS OR
IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A
PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO
EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR ANY
DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL,
EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES
(INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT
OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF
USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS
INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY
THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT,
STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING
NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF
ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
restlet (2.3.0)
Restlet is a lightweight, comprehensive, open source
REST framework for the Java platform. Restlet is
suitable for both server and client Web applications. It
supports major Internet transport, data format, and
service description standards like HTTP and HTTPS,
SMTP, XML, JSON, Atom, and WADL. The original
download site for this software is
: http://restlet.org This piece of software is made
available under the terms and conditions of the
Apache License version 2.
FaceBook SDK (3.0.1)
This TV contains Facebook SDK. The Facebook SDK
for Android is the easiest way to integrate your
42
Android app with Facebook's platform. The SDK
provides support for Login with Facebook
authentication, reading and writing to Facebook APIs
and support for UI elements such as pickers and
dialogs. The original download site for this software is
: https://developer.facebook.com/docs/android
This piece of software is made available under the
terms and conditions of the Apache License version 2.
ffmpeg (2.1.3)
This TV uses FFmpeg. FFmpeg is a complete, cross-
platform solution to record, convert and stream audio
and video. The original download site for this
software is : http://ffmpeg.org This piece of software
is made available under the terms and conditions of
the GPL v2 license, which can be found below.
gson (2.3)
This TV uses gson. Gson is a Java library that can be
used to convert Java Objects into their JSON
representation. It can also be used to convert a JSON
string to an equivalent Java object. Gson can work
with arbitrary Java objects including pre-existing
objects that you do not have source-code of. The
original download site for this software is
: https://code.google.com/p/google-gson/ . This
piece of software is made available under the terms
and conditions of the Apache License 2.0
This software includes an implementation of the AES
Cipher, licensed by Brian Gladman. The original
download site for this software is
: http://www.gladman.me.uk/
This piece of software
is licensed by Brian Gladman.
libUpNp (1.2.1)
The original download site for this software is
: http://upnp.sourceforge.net/ This piece of software
is made available under the terms and conditions of
the BSD.
live555 (0.82)
Live555 provides RTP/RTCP/RTSP client.The original
download site for this software is
: http://www.live555.com This piece of software is
made available under the terms and conditions of the
LGPL v2.1 license, which can be found below.
dnsmasq
Dnsmasq is a lightweight, easy to configure DNS
forwarder and DHCP server. The original download
site for this software is
:
https://android.googlesource.com/platform/external/
dnmasq This piece of software is made available
under the terms and conditions of the GPL v2 license,
which can be found below.
TomCrypt (1.1)
iwedia stack is using tomcrypt for sw decryption. The
original download site for this software is
:
http://manpages.ubuntu.com/manpages/saucy/man
3/libtomcrypt.3.html. This piece of software is made
available under the terms and conditions of the
WTFPL.
u-boot (2011-12)
U-boot is a boot loader for embedded boards based
on ARM, MIPS and other processors, which can be
installed in a boot ROM and used to initialize and test
the hardware or to download and run application
code. This piece of software is made available under
the terms and conditions of the GPL v2 license, which
can be found below.
AsyncHttpclient (1.4.9)
The original download site for this software is
: http://loopj.com/android-async-http/
This piece
of software is made available under the terms and
conditions of the APACHE LICENSE 2.0
httpclient-4.4.1.1 (4.4.1.1)
This is needed to import
cz.msebera.android.httpclient used by
AssyncHttpClientThe original download site for this
software is
:
http://mvnrepository.com/artifact/cz.msebera.androi
d/httpclient/4.4.1.1 This piece of software is made
available under the terms and conditions of the
APACHE LICENSE 2.0
Jackson Parser (2.x)
Ipepg client uses Jackson Parser for string
manipulation. The original download site for this
software is
: https://github.com/FasterXML/jackson-core This
piece of software is made available under the terms
and conditions of the APACHE LICENSE 2.0
audio a2dp (2.x)
Bluetooth stack. The original download site for this
software is
43
:
https://android.googlesource.com/platform/system/
bt This piece of software is made available under the
terms and conditions of the APACHE LICENSE 2.0
libexif (0.6.21)
Exif JPEG header manipulation tool. The original
download site for this software is
: http://libexif.sourceforge.net/ This piece of
software is made available under the terms and
conditions of the APACHE LICENSE 2.0
libexpat (2.1.0)
Expat XML Parser. The original download site for this
software is : http://www.libexpat.org/Expat is free
software. You may copy, distribute, and modify it
under the terms of the License contained in the file
COPYING distributed with this package. This license is
the same as the MIT/X Consortium license.
libFFTEm ( )
neven face recognition library. The original download
site for this software is : No info. This piece of
software is made available under the terms and
conditions of the APACHE LICENSE 2.0
libicui18n (49.1.1)
International Components for unicode. The original
download site for this software is
: http://icu-project.org This piece of software is
made available under the terms and conditions of the
BSD.
libiprouteutil (3.4.0)
iproute2 TCP/IP networking and traffic control. The
original download site for this software is
: http://www.linuxfoundation.org/ This piece of
software is made available under the terms and
conditions of the GPL v2. which can be found below
libjpeg (3.4.0)
libjpeg-turbo is a JPEG image codec that uses SIMD
instructions (MMX, SSE2, NEON) to accelerate
baseline JPEG compression and decompression on
x86, x86-64, and ARM systems. The original
download site for this software is
: http://www.ijg.org/libjpeg-turbo is covered by
three compatible BSD-style open source licenses.
Refer to LICENSE.txt for a roll-up of license terms.
libmtp (1.0.1)
libmtp The original download site for this software is
: http://libmtp.sourceforge.net/ . This piece of
software is made available under the terms and
conditions of the LGPL V2.
libmdnssd (320.10.80)
MDNS Responder. The mDNSResponder project is a
component of Bonjour, 5Apple's ease-of-use IP
networking initiative. The original download site for
this software is
:
http://www.opensource.apple.com/tarballs/mDNSRe
sponder/ This piece of software is made available
under the terms and conditions of the Apache license
version 2
libnfc_ndef ( )
The original download site for this software is : No
info. This piece of software is made available under
the terms and conditions of the Apache license
version 2
libskia ( )
skia 2D graphics library Skia is a complete 2D graphic
library for drawing Text, Geometries, and Images. The
original download site for this software is
: http://code.google.com/p/skia/ This piece of
software is made available under the terms and
conditions of the BSD.
libsonivox ( )
The original download site for this software is : No
info. This piece of software is made available under
the terms and conditions of the Android APACHE
License Version 2.
libsqlite (3.9.2)
SQLite database. The original download site for this
software is : http://www.sqlite.org This piece of
software is made available under the terms and
conditions of the Android APACHE License Version 2.
libttspico ( )
The original download site for this software is : No
info. This piece of software is made available under
the terms and conditions of the Android APACHE
License Version 2.
libtinyalsa ( )
tinyalsa: a small library to interface with ALSA in the
44
Linux kernel. The original download site for this
software is : No info. This piece of software is made
available under the terms and conditions of the BSD.
wpa_supplicant (0.8)
Library used by legacy HAL to talk to wpa_supplicant
daemon. The original download site for this software
is : http://hostap.epitest.fi/ This piece of software is
made available under the terms and conditions of the
GPLv2.
libz (1.2.8)
zlib compression library. The original download site
for this software is : http://zlib.net This piece of
software is made available under the terms and
conditions of the BSD.
iptables (1.4.20)
iptables is a user space application program that
allows a system administrator to configure the tables
provided by the Linux kernel firewall (implemented as
different Netfilter modules) and the chains and rules it
stores. Different kernel modules and programs are
currently used for different protocols; iptables applies
to IPv4The original download site for this software is
: https://android.googlesource.com/ This piece of
software is made available under the terms and
conditions of the GPLv2.
toolbox (1.2.8)
The 'toolbox' command in Android is a multi-function
program. It encapsulates the functionality of many
common Linux commands (and some special Android
ones) into a single binary. This makes it more
compact than having all those other commands
installed individually. The original download site for
this software is
: https://android.googlesource.com/ This piece of
software is made available under the terms and
conditions of the Android APACHE License Version 2.
libssl
(7b8b9c17db93ea5287575b437c77fb36eeb81b31)
BoringSSL The original download site for this software
is
: https://boringssl.googlesource.com/boringssl/ This
piece of software is made available under the terms
and conditions of the BSD.
libOpenMAXAL
(7b8b9c17db93ea5287575b437c77fb36eeb81b31)
OpenMAX AL is an application-level multimedia
playback and recording API for mobile embedded
devicesThe original download site for this software is
: https://www.khronos.org/openmax/ License free
libOpenSLES (1.0)
Khronos OpenSL Sound API spec. The original
download site for this software is
: https://www.khronos.org/opensles/ License free
libEGL libGLESv1_CM (3.1)
Khronos OpenGL Graphics API spec. The original
download site for this software is
: https://www.opengl.org/ License free
libffmpeg_av (2.1)
FFmpeg media player. The original download site for
this software is : https://ffmpeg.org/ This piece of
software is licensed under LGPL v2.1
libcurlmheg (7.21.6)
curl for MHEG. The original download site for this
software is : https://ffmpeg.org/ Curl and libcurl are
licensed under a MIT/X derivate license. Please look
at https://curl.haxx.se/docs/copyright.html
boringssl
(af0e32cb84f0c9cc65b9233a3414d2562642b342)
ssl for MHEG, Taken from android M. The original
download site for this software is
: https://boringssl.googlesource.com/boringssl/
Licensed under BSD, please find in /android/n-
base/external/boringssl/NOTICE
libpng (1.6.22beta)
libpng is the official Portable Network Graphics (PNG)
reference library (originally called pnglib). It is a
platform-independent library that contains C
functions for handling PNG images. It supports almost
all of PNG's features, is extensible. The original
download site for this software is
: https://github.com/julienr/libpng-android This
code is released under the libpng license.
Hue SDK (1.8.1)
TV ambihue app uses Philips SDK to find the hue
bridge name. The original download site for this
software is
:
https://developers.meethue.com/documentation/jav
a-multi-platform-and-android-sdk
45
Opera Web Browser (SDK 4.8.0)
This TV contains Opera Browser Software.
Third-party licenses
WebKit
name License
WebKit URL: http://webkit.org/
(WebKit doesn't distribute an explicit license. This
LICENSE is derived from license text in the source.)
Copyright (c) 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002,
2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007 Alexander Kellett,
Alexey Proskuryakov, Alex Mathews, Allan Sandfeld
Jensen, Alp Toker, Anders Carlsson, Andrew
Wellington, Antti Koivisto, Apple Inc., Arthur
Langereis, Baron Schwartz, Bjoern Graf, Brent
Fulgham, Cameron Zwarich, Charles Samuels,
Christian Dywan, Collabora Ltd., Cyrus Patel, Daniel
Molkentin, Dave Maclachlan, David Smith, Dawit
Alemayehu, Dirk Mueller, Dirk Schulze, Don Gibson,
Enrico Ros, Eric Seidel, Frederik Holljen, Frerich
Raabe, Friedmann Kleint, George Staikos, Google
Inc., Graham Dennis, Harri Porten, Henry
Mason, Hiroyuki Ikezoe, Holger Hans Peter Freyther,
IBM, James G. Speth, Jan Alonzo, Jean-Loup Gailly,
John Reis, Jonas Witt, Jon Shier, Jonas Witt, Julien
Chaffraix, Justin Haygood, Kevin Ollivier, Kevin
Watters, Kimmo Kinnunen, Kouhei Sutou, Krzysztof
Kowalczyk, Lars Knoll, Luca Bruno, Maks Orlovich,
Malte Starostik, Mark Adler, Martin Jones, Marvin
Decker, Matt Lilek, Michael Emmel, Mitz Pettel,
mozilla.org, Netscape Communications Corporation,
Nicholas Shanks, Nikolas Zimmermann, Nokia, Oliver
Hunt, Opened Hand, Paul Johnston, Peter Kelly,
Pioneer Research Center USA, Rich Moore, Rob Buis,
Robin Dunn, Ronald Tschalär, Samuel Weinig, Simon
Hausmann, Staikos Computing Services Inc., Stefan
Schimanski, Symantec Corporation, The
Dojo Foundation, The Karbon Developers, Thomas
Boyer, Tim Copperfield, Tobias Anton, Torben Weis,
Trolltech, University of Cambridge, Vaclav Slavik,
Waldo Bastian, Xan Lopez, Zack Rusin
The terms and conditions vary from file to file, but
are one of:
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms,
with or without modification, are permitted provided
that the following conditions are met:
*
OR*
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms,
with or without modification, are permitted provided
that the following conditions are met:
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY APPLE
COMPUTER, INC. ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR
IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A
PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO
EVENT SHALL APPLE COMPUTER, INC.
OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT,
INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT
LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE
GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA,
OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF
LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR
OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE
USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
GNU LIBRARY GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
Version 2, June 1991
Copyright (C) 1991 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301
USA
Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim
copies of this license document, but changing it is not
allowed.
Preamble
The licenses for most software are designed to take
away your freedom to share and change it. By
contrast, the GNU General Public Licenses are
intended to guarantee your freedom to share and
change free software--to make sure the software is
free for all its users.
This license, the Library General Public License,
applies to some specially designated Free Software
Foundation software, and to any other libraries
whose authors decide to use it. You can use it for
your libraries, too.
When we speak of free software, we are referring to
freedom, not price. Our General Public Licenses are
designed to make sure that you have the freedom to
distribute copies of free software (and charge for this
service if you wish), that you receive source code or
can get it if you want it, that you can change the
software or use pieces of it in new free programs; and
that you know you can do these things.
To protect your rights, we need to make restrictions
that forbid anyone to deny you these rights or to ask
you to surrender the rights. These restrictions
translate to certain responsibilities for you if you
distribute copies of the library, or if you modify it.
46
For example, if you distribute copies of the library,
whether gratis or for a fee, you must give the
recipients all the rights that we gave you. You must
make sure that they, too, receive or can get the
source code. If you link a program with the library,
you must provide complete object files to the
recipients so that they can relink them with the library,
after making changes to the library and recompiling it.
And you must show them these terms so they know
their rights.
Our method of protecting your rights has two steps:
(1) copyright the library, and (2) offer you this license
which gives you legal permission to copy, distribute
and/or modify the library.
Also, for each distributor's protection, we want to
make certain that everyone understands that there is
no warranty for this free library. If the library is
modified by someone else and passed on, we want
its recipients to know that what they have is not the
original version, so that any problems introduced by
others will not reflect on the original authors'
reputations.
Finally, any free program is threatened constantly by
software patents. We wish to avoid the danger that
companies distributing free software will individually
obtain patent licenses, thus in effect transforming the
program into proprietary software. To prevent this, we
have made it clear that any patent must be licensed
for everyone's free use or not licensed at all.
Most GNU software, including some libraries, is
covered by the ordinary GNU General Public License,
which was designed for utility programs. This license,
the GNU Library General Public License, applies to
certain designated libraries. This license is quite
different from the ordinary one; be sure to read it in
full, and don't assume that anything in it is the same
as in the ordinary license.
The reason we have a separate public license for
some libraries is that they blur the distinction we
usually make between modifying or adding to a
program and simply using it. Linking a program with
a library, without changing the library, is in some
sense simply using the library, and is analogous to
running a utility program or application program.
However, in a textual and legal sense, the linked
executable is a combined work, a derivative of the
original library, and the ordinary General Public
License treats it as such.
Because of this blurred distinction, using the ordinary
General Public License for libraries did not effectively
promote software sharing, because most developers
did not use the libraries. We concluded that weaker
conditions might promote sharing better.
However, unrestricted linking of non-free programs
would deprive the users of those programs of all
benefit from the free status of the libraries
themselves. This Library General Public License is
intended to permit developers of non-free programs
to use free libraries, while preserving your freedom as
a user of such programs to change the free libraries
that are incorporated in them. (We have not seen how
to achieve this as regards changes in header files, but
we have achieved it as regards changes in the actual
functions of the Library.) The hope is that this will lead
to faster development of free libraries.
The precise terms and conditions for copying,
distribution and modification follow. Pay close
attention to the difference between a"work based on
the library" and a "work that uses the library". The
former contains code derived from the library, while
the latter only works together with the library.
Note that it is possible for a library to be covered by
the ordinary General Public License rather than by
this special one.
GNU LIBRARY GENERAL
PUBLIC LICENSE
TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR COPYING,
DISTRIBUTION AND MODIFICATION
0. This License Agreement applies to any software
library which contains a notice placed by the
copyright holder or other authorized party saying it
may be distributed under the terms of this
Library General Public License (also called "this
License"). Each licensee is addressed as "you".
A "library" means a collection of software functions
and/or data prepared so as to be conveniently
linked with application programs (which use some of
those functions and data) to form executables.
The "Library", below, refers to any such software
library or work which has been distributed under
these terms. A "work based on the Library" means
either the Library or any derivative work
under copyright law: that is to say, a work containing
the Library or a portion of it, either verbatim or with
modifications and/or translated straightforwardly
into another language. (Hereinafter, translation
is included without limitation in the term
"modification".)
"Source code" for a work means the preferred form of
the work for making modifications to it. For a library,
complete source code means all the source code for
all modules it contains, plus any associate interface
definition files, plus the scripts used to control
compilation and installation of the library.
Activities other than copying, distribution and
modification are not covered by this License; they
are outside its scope. The act of running a program
using the Library is not restricted, and output
from such a program is covered only if its contents
constitute a work based on the Library (independent
47
of the use of the Library in a tool for writing it).
Whether that is true depends on what the Library
does and what the program that uses the Library
does.
1. You may copy and distribute verbatim copies of the
Library's complete source code as you receive it, in
any medium, provided that you conspicuously and
appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate
copyright notice and disclaimer of warranty; keep
intact all the notices that refer to this License and to
the absence of any warranty; and distribute a copy
of this License along with the
You may charge a fee for the physical act of
transferring a copy, and you may at your option offer
warranty protection in exchange for a
2. You may modify your copy or copies of the Library
or any portion of it, thus forming a work based on the
Library, and copy and distribute such modifications
or work under the terms of Section 1 above, provided
that you also meet all of these conditions:
a) The modified work must itself be a software
library.
b) You must cause the files modified to carry
prominent notices stating that you changed the files
and the date of any change.
c) You must cause the whole of the work to be
licensed at no charge to all third parties under the
terms of this License.
d) If a facility in the modified Library refers to a
function or a table of data to be supplied by an
application program that uses the facility, other than
as an argument passed when the facility is invoked,
then you must make a good faith effort to ensure
that, in the event an application does not supply
such function or table, the facility still operates, and
performs whatever part of its purpose remains
meaningful.
(For example, a function in a library to compute
square roots has a purpose that is entirely well-
defined independent of the application. Therefore,
Subsection 2d requires that any application-supplied
function or table used by this function must be
optional: if the application does not supply it, the
squareroot function must still compute square roots.)
These requirements apply to the modified work as a
whole. If identifiable sections of that work are not
derived from the Library, and can be reasonably
considered independent and separate works
in themselves, then this License, and its terms, do not
apply to those sections when you distribute them as
separate works. But when you distribute the same
sections as part of a whole which is a work based on
the Library, the distribution of the whole must be on
the terms of this License, whose permissions for
other licensees extend to the entire whole, and thus
to each and every part regardless of who
wrote. Thus, it is not the intent of this section to claim
rights or contest your rights to work written entirely
by you; rather, the intent is to exercise the right to
control the distribution of derivative or collective
works based on the Library.
In addition, mere aggregation of another work not
based on the Library with the Library (or with a work
based on the Library) on a volume of a storage or
distribution medium does not bring the other work
under the scope of this License.
3. You may opt to apply the terms of the ordinary
GNU General Public License instead of this License
to a given copy of the Library. To do this, you must
alter all the notices that refer to this License, so that
they refer to the ordinary GNU General Public
License, version 2, instead of to this License. (If a
newer version than version 2 of the ordinary GNU
General Public License has appeared, then you can
specify that version instead if you wish.) Do not
make any other change in these notices.
Once this change is made in a given copy, it is
irreversible for that copy, so the ordinary GNU
General Public License applies to all subsequent
copies and derivative works made from that copy.
This option is useful when you wish to copy part of
the code of the Library into a program that is not a
library.
4. You may copy and distribute the Library (or a
portion or derivative of it, under Section 2) in object
code or executable form under the terms of Sections
1 and 2 above provided that you accompany it with
the complete corresponding machine-readable
source code, which must be distributed under the
terms of Sections 1 and 2 above on a medium
customarily used for software interchange.
If distribution of object code is made by offering
access to copy from a designated place, then
offering equivalent access to copy the source code
from the same place satisfies the requirement
to distribute the source code, even though third
parties are not compelled to copy the source along
with the object code.
5. A program that contains no derivative of any
portion of the Library, but is designed to work with
the Library by being compiled or linked with it, is
called a "work that uses the Library". Such a work, in
isolation, is not a derivative work of the Library,
and therefore falls outside the scope of this License.
However, linking a "work that uses the Library" with
the Library creates an executable that is a derivative
of the Library (because it contains portions of the
Library), rather than a "work that uses the library".
The executable is therefore covered by this License.
48
Section 6 states terms for distribution of such
executables.
When a "work that uses the Library" uses material
from a header file that is part of the Library, the
object code for the work may be a derivative work of
the Library even though the source code is
not. Whether this is true is especially significant if the
work can be linked without the Library, or if the work
is itself a library. The threshold for this to be true is
not precisely defined by law.
If such an object file uses only numerical parameters,
data structure layouts and accessors, and small
macros and small inline functions (ten lines or less in
length), then the use of the object file is unrestricted,
regardless of whether it is legally a derivative
work. (Executables containing this object code plus
portions of the Library will still fall under Section 6.)
Otherwise, if the work is a derivative of the Library,
you may distribute the object code for the work
under the terms of Section 6. Any executables
containing that work also fall under Section
6, whether or not they are linked directly with the
Library itself.
6. As an exception to the Sections above, you may
also compile or link a "work that uses the Library"
with the Library to produce a work containing
portions of the Library, and distribute that
work under terms of your choice, provided that the
terms permit modification of the work for the
customer's own use and reverse engineering for
debugging such modifications.
You must give prominent notice with each copy of
the work that the Library is used in it and that the
Library and its use are covered by this License. You
must supply a copy of this License. If the
work during execution displays copyright notices,
you must include the copyright notice for the Library
among them, as well as a reference directing the user
to the copy of this License. Also, you must do
one of these things:
a) Accompany the work with the complete
corresponding machine-readable source code for
the Library including whateve changes were used in
the work (which must be distributed under Sections 1
and 2 above); and, if the work is an executable
linked with the Library, with the complete machine-
readable "work that uses the Library", as object code
and/or source code, so that the user can modify the
Library and then relink to produce a
modified executable containing the modified
Library. (It is understood that the user who changes
the contents of definitions files in the Library will not
necessarily be able to recompile the application to
use the modified definitions.)
b) Accompany the work with a written offer, valid
for at least three years, to give the same user the
materials specified in Subsection 6a, above, for a
charge no more than the cost of performing this
distribution.
c) If distribution of the work is made by offering
access to copy from a designated place, offer
equivalent access to copy the above specified
materials from the same place.
d) Verify that the user has already received a
copy of these materials or that you have already sent
this user a copy.
For an executable, the required form of the "work that
uses the Library" must include any data and utility
programs needed for reproducing the executable
from it. However, as a special exception, the source
code distributed need not include anything that is
normally distributed (in either source or binary form)
with the major components (compiler, kernel, and so
on) of the operating system on which the executable
runs, unless that component itself accompanies the
executable.
It may happen that this requirement contradicts the
license restrictions of other proprietary libraries that
do not normally accompany the operating system.
Such a contradiction means you cannot use both
them and the Library together in an executable that
you distribute.
7. You may place library facilities that are a work
based on the Library side-by-side in a single library
together with other library facilities not covered by
this License, and distribute such a combined library,
provided that the separate distribution of the work
based on the Library and of the other library facilities
is otherwise permitted, and provided that you do
these two things:
a) Accompany the combined library with a copy
of the same work based on the Library, uncombined
with any other library facilities. This must be
distributed under the terms of the Sections above.
b) Give prominent notice with the combined
library of the fact that part of it is a work based on
the Library, and explaining where to find the
accompanying uncombined form of the same work.
8. You may not copy, modify, sublicense, link with, or
distribute the Library except as expressly provided
under this License. Any attempt otherwise to copy,
modify, sublicense, link with, or distribute the Library
is void, and will automatically terminate your rights
under this License. However, parties who have
received copies, or rights, from you under this
License will not have their licenses terminated so
long as such parties remain in full compliance.
9. You are not required to accept this License, since
you have not signed it. However, nothing else
grants you permission to modify or distribute the
Library or its derivative works. These actions
49
are prohibited by law if you do not accept this
License. Therefore, by modifying or distributing the
Library (or any work based on the Library), you
indicate your acceptance of this License to do so,
and all its terms and conditions for copying,
distributing or modifying the Library or works based
on it.
10. Each time you redistribute the Library (or any work
based on the Library), the recipient automatically
receives a license from the original licensor to copy,
distribute, link with or modify the Library subject to
these terms and conditions. You may not impose
any further restrictions on the recipients' exercise of
the rights granted herein. You are not responsible for
enforcing compliance by third parties to this License.
11. If, as a consequence of a court judgment or
allegation of patent infringement or for any other
reason (not limited to patent issues), conditions are
imposed on you (whether by court order, agreement
or otherwise) that contradict the conditions of this
License, they do not excuse you from the conditions
of this License. If you cannot distribute so as to
satisfy simultaneously your obligations under
this License and any other pertinent obligations, then
as a consequence you may not distribute the Library
at all. For example, if a patent license would not
permit royalty-free redistribution of the Library by all
those who receive copies directly or indirectly
through you, then the only way you could satisfy
both it and this License would be to refrain entirely
from distribution of the Library.
If any portion of this section is held invalid or
unenforceable under any particular circumstance,
the balance of the section is intended to apply, and
the section as a whole is intended to apply in other
circumstances.
It is not the purpose of this section to induce you to
infringe any patents or other property right claims or
to contest validity of any such claims; this section
has the sole purpose of protecting the integrity of the
free software distribution system which
is implemented by public license practices. Many
people have made generous contributions to the
wide range of software distributed through that
system in reliance on consistent application of
that system; it is up to the author/donor to decide if
he or she is willing to distribute software through any
other system and a licensee cannot impose that
choice.
This section is intended to make thoroughly clear
what is believed to be a consequence of the rest of
this License.
12. If the distribution and/or use of the Library is
restricted in certain countries either by patents or by
copyrighted interfaces, the original copyright holder
who places the Library under this License may
add an explicit geographical distribution limitation
excluding those countries, so that distribution is
permitted only in or among countries not thus
excluded. In such case, this License incorporates the
limitation as if written in the body of this License.
13. The Free Software Foundation may publish
revised and/or new versions of the Library General
Public License from time to time. Such new versions
will be similar in spirit to the present version, but may
differ in detail to address new problems or concerns.
Each version is given a distinguishing version
number. If the Library specifies a version number of
this License which applies to it and "any later
version", you have the option of following the terms
and conditions either of that version or of any later
version published by the Free Software Foundation.
If the Library does not specify a license version
number, you may choose any version ever published
by the Free Software Foundation.
14. If you wish to incorporate parts of the Library into
other free programs whose distribution conditions
are incompatible with these, write to the author to
ask for permission. For software which
is copyrighted by the Free Software Foundation,
write to the Free Software Foundation; we
sometimes make exceptions for this. Our decision
will be guided by the two goals of preserving the free
status of all derivatives of our free software and of
promoting the sharing and reuse of software
generally.
NO WARRANTY
15. BECAUSE THE LIBRARY IS LICENSED FREE OF
CHARGE, THERE IS NO
WARRANTY FOR THE LIBRARY, TO THE EXTENT
PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW.
EXCEPT WHEN OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING
THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND/OR
OTHER PARTIES PROVIDE THE LIBRARY "AS IS"
WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY
KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING,
BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.
THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO THE QUALITY AND
PERFORMANCE OF THE
LIBRARY IS WITH YOU. SHOULD THE LIBRARY
PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME
THE COST OF ALL NECESSARY SERVICING, REPAIR
OR CORRECTION.
16. IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE
LAW OR AGREED TO IN
WRITING WILL ANY COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY
OTHER PARTY WHO MAY MODIFY
50
AND/OR REDISTRIBUTE THE LIBRARY AS
PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU
FOR DAMAGES, INCLUDING ANY GENERAL,
SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL OR
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES ARISING OUT OF THE
USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE
LIBRARY (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO LOSS OF
DATA OR DATA BEING
RENDERED INACCURATE OR LOSSES SUSTAINED BY
YOU OR THIRD PARTIES OR A
FAILURE OF THE LIBRARY TO OPERATE WITH ANY
OTHER SOFTWARE), EVEN IF
SUCH HOLDER OR OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN
ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
END OF TERMS AND
CONDITIONS
GNU LESSER GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
Version 2.1, February 1999
Copyright (C) 1991, 1999 Free Software Foundation,
Inc.
51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
02110-1301 USA
Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim
copies of this license document, but changing it is
not allowed.
[This is the first released version of the Lesser GPL. It
also counts as the successor of the GNU Library
Public License, version 2, hence the version number
2.1.]
Preamble
The licenses for most software are designed to take
away your freedom to share and change it. By
contrast, the GNU General Public Licenses are
intended to guarantee your freedom to share and
change free software--to make sure the software is
free for all its users.
This license, the Lesser General Public License,
applies to some specially designated software
packages--typically libraries--of the Free Software
Foundation and other authors who decide to use it.
You can use it too, but we suggest you first think
carefully about whether this license or the ordinary
General Public License is the better strategy to use in
any particular case, based on the explanations below.
When we speak of free software, we are referring to
freedom of use, not price. Our General Public
Licenses are designed to make sure that you have
the freedom to distribute copies of free software (and
charge for this service if you wish); that you receive
source code or can get it if you want it; that you can
change the software and use pieces of it in new free
programs; and that you are informed that you can
do these things.
To protect your rights, we need to make restrictions
that forbid distributors to deny you these rights or to
ask you to surrender these rights. These restrictions
translate to certain responsibilities for you if you
distribute copies of the library or if you modify it.
For example, if you distribute copies of the library,
whether gratis or for a fee, you must give the
recipients all the rights that we gave you. You must
make sure that they, too, receive or can get the
source code. If you link other code with the library,
you must provide complete object files to the
recipients, so that they can relink them with the
library after making changes to the library and
recompiling it. And you must show them these terms
so they know their rights.
We protect your rights with a two-step method: (1) we
copyright the library, and (2) we offer you this
license, which gives you legal permission to copy,
distribute and/or modify the library.
To protect each distributor, we want to make it very
clear that there is no warranty for the free library.
Also, if the library is modified by someone else and
passed on, the recipients should know that what
they have is not the original version, so that the
original author's reputation will not be affected by
problems that might be introduced by others.
Finally, software patents pose a constant threat to the
existence of any free program. We wish to make
sure that a company cannot effectively restrict the
users of a free program by obtaining a restrictive
license from a patent holder. Therefore, we insist
that any patent license obtained for a version of the
library must be consistent with the full freedom of
use specified in this license.
Most GNU software, including some libraries, is
covered by the ordinary GNU General Public
License. This license, the GNU Lesser General
Public License, applies to certain designated libraries,
and is quite different from the ordinary General
Public License. We use this license for certain
libraries in order to permit linking those libraries into
non-free programs.
When a program is linked with a library, whether
statically or using a shared library, the combination
of the two is legally speaking a combined work, a
derivative of the original library. The
ordinary General Public License therefore permits
such linking only if the entire combination fits its
criteria of freedom. The Lesser General Public
License permits more lax criteria for linking other code
with the library.
We call this license the "Lesser" General Public
51
License because it does Less to protect the user's
freedom than the ordinary General Public License.
It also provides other free software developers
Less of an advantage over competing non-free
programs. These disadvantages are the reason we
use the ordinary General Public License for
many libraries. However, the Lesser license provides
advantages in certain special circumstances.
For example, on rare occasions, there may be a
special need to encourage the widest possible use of
a certain library, so that it becomes a de-facto
standard. To achieve this, non-free programs must
be allowed to use the library. A more frequent case
is that a free library does the same job as widely
used non-free libraries. In this case, there is little to
gain by limiting the free library to free software only,
so we use the Lesser General Public License.
In other cases, permission to use a particular library in
non-free programs enables a greater number of
people to use a large body of free software. For
example, permission to use the GNU C Library in non-
free programs enables many more people to use the
whole GNU operating system, as well as its variant,
the GNU/Linux operating system.
Although the Lesser General Public License is Less
protective of the users' freedom, it does ensure that
the user of a program that is linked with the Library
has the freedom and the wherewithal to run that
program using a modified version of the Library.
The precise terms and conditions for copying,
distribution and modification follow. Pay close
attention to the difference between a "work based
on the library" and a "work that uses the library".
The former contains code derived from the library,
whereas the latter must be combined with the library
in order to run.
GNU LESSER GENERAL
PUBLIC LICENSE
TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR COPYING,
DISTRIBUTION AND MODIFICATION
0. This License Agreement applies to any software
library or other program which contains a notice
placed by the copyright holder or other authorized
party saying it may be distributed under the terms
of this Lesser General Public License (also called
"this License"). Each licensee is addressed as "you".
A "library" means a collection of software functions
and/or data prepared so as to be conveniently
linked with application programs (which use some of
those functions and data) to form executables.
The "Library", below, refers to any such software
library or work which has been distributed under
these terms. A "work based on the Library" means
either the Library or any derivative work
under copyright law: that is to say, a work containing
the Library or a portion of it, either verbatim or with
modifications and/or translated straightforwardly
into another language. (Hereinafter, translation
is included without limitation in the term
"modification".)
"Source code" for a work means the preferred form of
the work for making modifications to it. For a library,
complete source code means all the source code for
all modules it contains, plus any associated interface
definition files, plus the scripts used to control
compilation and installation of the library.
Activities other than copying, distribution and
modification are not covered by this License; they
are outside its scope. The act of running a program
using the Library is not restricted, and output
from such a program is covered only if its contents
constitute a work based on the Library (independent
of the use of the Library in a tool for writing it).
Whether that is true depends on what the Library
does and what the program that uses the Library
does.
1. You may copy and distribute verbatim copies of the
Library's complete source code as you receive it, in
any medium, provided that you conspicuously and
appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate
copyright notice and disclaimer of warranty; keep
intact all the notices that refer to this License and to
the absence of any warranty; and distribute a copy
of this License along with the Library.
You may charge a fee for the physical act of
transferring a copy, and you may at your option offer
warranty protection in exchange for a fee.
2. You may modify your copy or copies of the Library
or any portion of it, thus forming a work based on the
Library, and copy and distribute such modifications
or work under the terms of Section 1 above, provided
that you also meet all of these conditions:
a) The modified work must itself be a software
library.
b) You must cause the files modified to carry
prominent noticesstating that you changed the files
and the date of any change.
c) You must cause the whole of the work to be
licensed at no charge to all third parties under the
terms of this License.
d) If a facility in the modified Library refers to a
function or a table of data to be supplied by an
application program that uses the facility, other than
as an argument passed when the facility is invoked,
then you must make a good faith effort to ensure
that, in the event an application does not supply
such function or table, the facility still operates, and
performs whatever part of its purpose remains
meaningful.
52
(For example, a function in a library to compute
square roots has a purpose that is entirely well-
defined independent of the application. Therefore,
Subsection 2d requires that any application-supplied
function or table used by this function must be
optional: if the application does not supply it, the
square root function must still compute square
roots.)
These requirements apply to the modified work as a
whole. If identifiable sections of that work are not
derived from the Library, and can be reasonably
considered independent and separate works
in themselves, then this License, and its terms, do not
apply to those sections when you distribute them as
separate works. But when you distribute the same
sections as part of a whole which is a work based on
the Library, the distribution of the whole must be on
the terms of this License, whose permissions for
other licensees extend to the entire whole, and thus
to each and every part regardless of who wrote
Thus, it is not the intent of this section to claim rights
or contest your rights to work written entirely by you;
rather, the intent is to exercise the right to control the
distribution of derivative or collective works based on
the Library.
In addition, mere aggregation of another work not
based on the Library with the Library (or with a work
based on the Library) on a volume of a storage or
distribution medium does not bring the other work
under the scope of this License.
3. You may opt to apply the terms of the ordinary
GNU General Public License instead of this License
to a given copy of the Library. To do this, you must
alter all the notices that refer to this License, so that
they refer to the ordinary GNU General Public
License, version 2, instead of to this License. (If a
newer version than version 2 of the ordinary GNU
General Public License has appeared, then you can
specify that version instead if you wish.) Do not
make any other change in these notices.
Once this change is made in a given copy, it is
irreversible for that copy, so the ordinary GNU
General Public License applies to all subsequent
copies and derivative works made from that copy.
This option is useful when you wish to copy part of
the code of the Library into a program that is not a
library.
4. You may copy and distribute the Library (or a
portion or derivative of it, under Section 2) in object
code or executable form under the terms of Sections
1 and 2 above provided that you accompany it with
the complete corresponding machine-readable
source code, which must be distributed under the
terms of Sections 1 and 2 above on a medium
customarily used for software interchange.
If distribution of object code is made by offering
access to copy from a designated place, then
offering equivalent access to copy the source code
from the same place satisfies the requirement
to distribute the source code, even though third
parties are not compelled to copy the source along
with the object code.
5. A program that contains no derivative of any
portion of the Library, but is designed to work with
the Library by being compiled or linked with it, is
called a "work that uses the Library". Such a work, in
isolation, is not a derivative work of the Library,
and therefore falls outside the scope of this License.
However, linking a "work that uses the Library" with
the Library creates an executable that is a derivative
of the Library (because it contains portions of the
Library), rather than a "work that uses the library".
The executable is therefore covered by this License.
Section 6 states terms for distribution of such
executables.
When a "work that uses the Library" uses material
from a header file that is part of the Library, the
object code for the work may be a derivative work of
the Library even though the source code is
not. Whether this is true is especially significant if the
work can be linked without the Library, or if the work
is itself a library. The threshold for this to be true is
not precisely defined by law.
If such an object file uses only numerical parameters,
data structure layouts and accessors, and small
macros and small inline functions (ten lines or less in
length), then the use of the object file is unrestricted,
regardless of whether it is legally a derivative
work. (Executables containing this object code plus
portions of the Library will still fall under Section 6.)
Otherwise, if the work is a derivative of the Library,
you may distribute the object code for the work
under the terms of Section 6. Any executables
containing that work also fall under Section
6, whether or not they are linked directly with the
Library itself.
6. As an exception to the Sections above, you may
also combine or link a "work that uses the Library"
with the Library to produce a work containing
portions of the Library, and distribute that
work under terms of your choice, provided that the
terms permit modification of the work for the
customer's own use and reverse engineering for
debugging such modifications.
You must give prominent notice with each copy of the
work that the Library is used in it and that the Library
and its use are covered by this License. You must
supply a copy of this License. If the work during
execution displays copyright notices, you must
include the copyright notice for the Library among
them, as well as a reference directing the user to the
copy of this License. Also, you must do one of
53
these things:
a) Accompany the work with the complete
corresponding machine-readable source code for
the Library including whatever changes were used in
the work (which must be distributed under Sections 1
and 2 above); and, if the work is an executable
linked with the Library, with the complete machine-
readable "work that uses the Library", as object code
and/or source code, so that the user can modify the
Library and then relink to produce a
modified executable containing the modified
Library. (It is understood that the user who changes
the contents of definitions files in the Library will not
necessarily be able to recompile the application to
use the modified definitions.)
b) Use a suitable shared library mechanism for
linking with the Library. A suitable mechanism is
one that (1) uses at run time a copy of the library
already present on the user's computer syste rather
than copying library functions into the executable,
and (2) will operate properly with a modified version
of the library, if the user installs one, as long as the
modified version is interface-compatible with the
version that the work was made with.
c) Accompany the work with a written offer, valid
for at least three years, to give the same user the
materials specified in Subsection 6a, above, for a
charge no more than the cost of performing this
distribution.
d) If distribution of the work is made by offering
access to copy from a designated place, offer
equivalent access to copy the above specified
materials from the same place.
e) Verify that the user has already received a copy
of these materials or that you have already sent this
user a copy.
For an executable, the required form of the "work that
uses the Library" must include any data and utility
programs needed for reproducing the executable
from it. However, as a special exception, the
materials to be distributed need not include anything
that is normally distributed (in either source or binary
form) with the major components (compiler, kernel,
and so on) of the operating system on which the
executable runs, unless that component itself
accompanies the executable.
It may happen that this requirement contradicts the
license restrictions of other proprietary libraries that
do not normally accompany the operating system.
Such a contradiction means you cannot use both
them and the Library together in an executable that
you
7. You may place library facilities that are a work
based on the Library side-by-side in a single library
together with other library facilities not covered by
this License, and distribute such a combined library,
provided that the separate distribution of the work
based on the Library and of the other library facilities
is otherwise permitted, and provided that you do
these two things:
a) Accompany the combined library with a copy
of the same work based on the Library, uncombined
with any other library facilities. This must be
distributed under the terms of the Sections above.
b) Give prominent notice with the combined
library of the fact that part of it is a work based on
the Library, and explaining where to find the
accompanying uncombined form of the same work.
8. You may not copy, modify, sublicense, link with, or
distribute the Library except as expressly provided
under this License. Any attempt otherwise to copy,
modify, sublicense, link with, or distribute the Library
is void, and will automatically terminate your rights
under this License. However, parties who have
received copies, or rights, from you under this
License will not have their licenses terminated so
long as such parties remain in full compliance.
9. You are not required to accept this License, since
you have not signed it. However, nothing else
grants you permission to modify or distribute the
Library or its derivative works. These actions
are prohibited by law if you do not accept this
License. Therefore, by modifying or distributing the
Library (or any work based on the Library), you
indicate your acceptance of this License to do so,
and all its terms and conditions for copying,
distributing or modifying the Library or works based
on it.
10. Each time you redistribute the Library (or any work
based on the Library), the recipient automatically
receives a license from the original licensor to copy,
distribute, link with or modify the Library subject to
these terms and conditions. You may not impose
any further restrictions on the recipients' exercise of
the rights granted herein. You are not responsible for
enforcing compliance by third parties with this
License.
11. If, as a consequence of a court judgment or
allegation of patent infringement or for any other
reason (not limited to patent issues), conditions are
imposed on you (whether by court order, agreement
or otherwise) that contradict the conditions of this
License, they do not excuse you from the conditions
of this License. If you cannot distribute so as to
satisfy simultaneously your obligations under
this License and any other pertinent obligations, then
as a consequence you may not distribute the Library
at all. For example, if a patent license would not
permit royalty-free redistribution of the Library by all
those who receive copies directly or indirectly
through you, then the only way you could satisfy
both it and this License would be to refrain entirely
from distribution of the Library.
54
If any portion of this section is held invalid or
unenforceable under any particular circumstance,
the balance of the section is intended to apply, and
the section as a whole is intended to apply in other
circumstances.
It is not the purpose of this section to induce you to
infringe any patents or other property right claims or
to contest validity of any such claims; this section
has the sole purpose of protecting the integrity of the
free software distribution system which
is implemented by public license practices. Many
people have made generous contributions to the
wide range of software distributed through that
system in reliance on consistent application of
that system; it is up to the author/donor to decide if
he or she is willing to distribute software through any
other system and a licensee cannot impose that
choice.
This section is intended to make thoroughly clear
what is believed to be a consequence of the rest of
this License.
12. If the distribution and/or use of the Library is
restricted in certain countries either by patents or by
copyrighted interfaces, the original copyright holder
who places the Library under this License may
add an explicit geographical distribution limitation
excluding those countries, so that distribution is
permitted only in or among countries not thus
excluded. In such case, this License incorporates the
limitation as if written in the body of this License.
13. The Free Software Foundation may publish
revised and/or new versions of the Lesser General
Public License from time to time. Such new versions
will be similar in spirit to the present version, but may
differ in detail to address new problems or concerns.
Each version is given a distinguishing version
number. If the Library specifies a version number of
this License which applies to it and "any later
version", you have the option of following the terms
and conditions either of that version or of any later
version published by the Free Software Foundation.
If the Library does not specify a license version
number, you may choose any version ever published
by the Free Software Foundation.
14. If you wish to incorporate parts of the Library into
other free programs whose distribution conditions
are incompatible with these, write to the author to
ask for permission. For software which
is copyrighted by the Free Software Foundation,
write to the Free Software Foundation; we
sometimes make exceptions for this. Our decision
will be guided by the two goals of preserving the free
status of all derivatives of our free software and of
promoting the sharing and reuse of software
generally.
NO WARRANTY
15. BECAUSE THE LIBRARY IS LICENSED FREE OF
CHARGE, THERE IS NO
WARRANTY FOR THE LIBRARY, TO THE EXTENT
PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW.
EXCEPT WHEN OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING
THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND/OR
OTHER PARTIES PROVIDE THE LIBRARY "AS IS"
WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY
KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING,
BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO THE QUALITY
AND PERFORMANCE OF THE
LIBRARY IS WITH YOU. SHOULD THE LIBRARY
PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME
THE COST OF ALL NECESSARY SERVICING, REPAIR
OR CORRECTION.
16. IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY
APPLICABLE LAW OR AGREED TO IN
WRITING WILL ANY COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY
OTHER PARTY WHO MAY MODIFY
AND/OR REDISTRIBUTE THE LIBRARY AS
PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU
FOR DAMAGES, INCLUDING ANY GENERAL,
SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL OR
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES ARISING OUT OF THE
USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE
LIBRARY (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO LOSS OF
DATA OR DATA BEING
RENDERED INACCURATE OR LOSSES SUSTAINED BY
YOU OR THIRD PARTIES OR A
FAILURE OF THE LIBRARY TO OPERATE WITH ANY
OTHER SOFTWARE), EVEN IF
SUCH HOLDER OR OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN
ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
END OF TERMS AND
CONDITIONS
Other
name License
Chromium URL: http://www.chromium.org
Copyright (c) 2013 The Chromium Authors. All rights
reserved.
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms,
55
with or without modification, are permitted provided
that the following conditions are met:
* Redistributions of source code must retain the
above copyright
notice, this list of conditions and the following
disclaimer.
* Redistributions in binary form must reproduce
the above
copyright notice, this list of conditions and the
following disclaimer
in the documentation and/or other materials provided
with the
* Neither the name of Google Inc. nor the names
of its
contributors may be used to endorse or promote
products derived from
this software without specific prior written permission.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT
HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS
"AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED
WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR
A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO
EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT
OWNER OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY
DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL,
SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT
LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE
GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE,
DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY
THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT,
STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT
(INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING
IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE
OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
--
The following files are distributed under the MPL
1.1/GPL 2.0/LGPL 2.1 tri-license:
chromium-nss.h
chromium-blapi.h
chromium-blapit.h
chromium-sha256.h
chromium-prtypes.h
The following files contain portions distributed under
the MPL 1.1/GPL 2.0/LGPL 2.1 tri-license:
registry_controlled_domains/registry_controlled_dom
ain.cc
registry_controlled_domains/registry_controlled_dom
ain.h
The following files are distributed under the MPL 2.0
license:
Fontconfig
URL: http://www.fontconfig.org
Copyright © 2000,2001,2002,2003,2004,2006,2007
Keith Packard
Copyright © 2005 Patrick Lam
Copyright © 2009 Roozbeh Pournader
Copyright © 2008,2009 Red Hat, Inc.
Copyright © 2008 Danilo Šegan
Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell
this software and its
documentation for any purpose is hereby granted
without fee, provided that
the above copyright notice appear in all copies and
that both that
copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
supporting
documentation, and that the name of the author(s)
not be used in
advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of
the software without
specific, written prior permission. The authors make
no
representations about the suitability of this software
for any purpose. It
is provided "as is" without express or implied
warranty.
THE AUTHOR(S) DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH
REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE,
INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO
56
EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR(S) BE LIABLE FOR ANY
SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE,
DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF
CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER
TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING OUT OF OR IN
CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR
PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
Arphic fonts
URL:
http://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/CJKUnifo
nts/Download
ARPHIC PUBLIC LICENSE
Copyright (C) 1999 Arphic Technology Co., Ltd.
All rights reserved except as specified below.
Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim
copies of this license document, but changing it is
forbidden.
Preamble
The licenses for most software are designed to
take away your freedom to share and change it. By
contrast, the ARPHIC PUBLIC LICENSE specifically
permits and encourages you to use this software,
provided that you give the recipients all the rights that
we gave you and make sure they can get the
modifications of this software.
Legal Terms
Throughout this License, "Font" means the
TrueType fonts "AR PL Mingti2L Big5", "AR PL KaitiM
Big5" (BIG-5 character set) and "AR PL SungtiL GB",
"AR PL KaitiM GB" (GB character set) which are
originally distributed by Arphic, and the derivatives of
those fonts created through any modification
including modifying glyph, reordering glyph,
converting format, changing font name, or
adding/deleting some characters in/from glyph table.
"PL" means "Public License".
"Copyright Holder" means whoever is named in
the copyright or copyrights for the Font.
"You" means the licensee, or person copying,
redistributing or modifying the Font.
"Freely Available" means that you have the
freedom to copy or modify the Font as well as
redistribute copies of the Font under the same
conditions you received, not price. If you wish, you
can charge for this service.
You may copy and distribute verbatim copies of
this Font in any medium, without restriction, provided
that you retain this license file (ARPHICPL.TXT)
unaltered in all copies.
You may otherwise modify your copy of this Font
in any way, including modifying glyph, reordering
glyph, converting format, changing font name, or
adding/deleting some characters in/from glyph table,
and copy and distribute such modifications under the
terms of Section 1 above, provided that the following
conditions are met:
a) You must insert a prominent notice in each
modified file stating how and when you changed that
file.
b) You must make such modifications Freely
Available as a whole to all third parties under the
terms of this License, such as by offering access to
copy the modifications from a designated place, or
distributing the modifications on a medium
customarily used for software interchange.
c) If the modified fonts normally reads
commands interactively when run, you must cause it,
when started running for such interactive use in the
most ordinary way, to print or display an
announcement including an appropriate copyright
notice and a notice that there is no warranty (or else,
saying that you provide a warranty) and that users
may redistribute the Font under these conditions, and
telling the user how to view a copy of this License.
These requirements apply to the modified work
as a whole. If identifiable sections of that work are not
derived from the Font, and can be reasonably
considered independent and separate works in
themselves, then this License and its terms, do not
apply to those sections when you distribute them as
separate works. Therefore, mere aggregation of
another work not based on the Font with the Font on
a volume of a storage or distribution medium does
not bring the other work under the scope of this
License.
You may not copy, modify, sublicense, or
distribute the Font except as expressly provided
under this License. Any attempt otherwise to copy,
modify, sublicense or distribute the Font will
automatically retroactively void your rights under this
License. However, parties who have received copies
or rights from you under this License will keep their
licenses valid so long as such parties remain in full
compliance.
You are not required to accept this License, since
you have not signed it. However, nothing else grants
you permission to copy, modify, sublicense or
distribute the Font. These actions are prohibited by
law if you do not accept this License. Therefore, by
copying, modifying, sublicensing or distributing the
57
Font, you indicate your acceptance of this License
and all its terms and conditions.
Each time you redistribute the Font, the recipient
automatically receives a license from the original
licensor to copy, distribute or modify the Font subject
to these terms and conditions. You may not impose
any further restrictions on the recipients' exercise of
the rights granted herein. You are not responsible for
enforcing compliance by third parties to this License.
If, as a consequence of a court judgment or
allegation of patent infringement or for any other
reason (not limited to patent issues), conditions are
imposed on you (whether by court order, agreement
or otherwise) that contradict the conditions of this
License, they do not excuse you from the conditions
of this License. If you cannot distribute so as to satisfy
simultaneously your obligations under this License
and any other pertinent obligations, then as a
consequence you may not distribute the Font at all.
For example, if a patent license would not permit
royalty-free redistribution of the Font by all those
who receive copies directly or indirectly through you,
then the only way you could satisfy both it and this
License would be to refrain entirely from distribution
of the Font.
If any portion of this section is held invalid or
unenforceable under any particular circumstance, the
balance of the section is intended to apply and the
section as a whole is intended to apply in other
circumstances.
BECAUSE THE FONT IS LICENSED FREE OF
CHARGE, THERE IS NO WARRANTY FOR THE FONT,
TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW.
EXCEPT WHEN OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING
THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS OR OTHER PARTIES
PROVIDE THE FONT "AS IS" WITHOUT WARRANTY
OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED,
INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE IMPLIED
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS
FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE RISK AS
TO THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF THE
FONT IS WITH YOU. SHOULD THE FONT PROVE
DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF ALL
NECESSARY SERVICING, REPAIR OR CORRECTION.
UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW OR
AGREED TO IN WRITING, IN NO EVENT WILL ANY
COPYRIGHTT HOLDERS, OR OTHER PARTIES WHO
MAY COPY, MODIFY OR REDISTRIBUTE THE FONT
AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR ANY
DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, INCIDENTAL,
SPECIAL OR EXEMPLARY DAMAGES ARISING OUT
OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE FONT
(INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO PROCUREMENT
OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF
USE, DATA OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS
INTERRUPTION), EVEN IF SUCH HOLDERS OR
OTHER PARTIES HAVE BEEN ADVISED OF THE
POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.
Bitstream Vera fonts
URL:
http://www.gnome.org/fonts/#Final_Bitstream_Vera
_Fonts
Bitstream Vera Fonts Copyright
The fonts have a generous copyright, allowing
derivative works (as long as "Bitstream" or "Vera" are
not in the names), and full redistribution (so long as
they are not *sold* by themselves). They can be be
bundled, redistributed and sold with any software.
The fonts are distributed under the following
copyright:
Copyright
=========
Copyright (c) 2003 by Bitstream, Inc. All Rights
Reserved. Bitstream
Vera is a trademark of Bitstream, Inc.
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any
person obtaining
a copy of the fonts accompanying this license
("Fonts") and associated
documentation files (the "Font Software"), to
reproduce and distribute
the Font Software, including without limitation the
rights to use,
copy, merge, publish, distribute, and/or sell copies of
the Font
Software, and to permit persons to whom the Font
Software is furnished
to do so, subject to the following conditions:
The above copyright and trademark notices and this
permission notice
shall be included in all copies of one or more of the
Font Software
The Font Software may be modified, altered, or
added to, and in
particular the designs of glyphs or characters in the
Fonts may be
modified and additional glyphs or characters may be
added to the
Fonts, only if the fonts are renamed to names not
containing either
the words "Bitstream" or the word "Vera".
This License becomes null and void to the extent
applicable to Fonts
or Font Software that has been modified and is
distributed under the
58
"Bitstream Vera" names.
The Font Software may be sold as part of a larger
software package but
no copy of one or more of the Font Software
typefaces may be sold by itself.
THE FONT SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS",
WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND,
EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT
LIMITED TO ANY WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT
OF COPYRIGHT, PATENT, TRADEMARK, OR OTHER
RIGHT. IN NO EVENT SHALL
BITSTREAM OR THE GNOME FOUNDATION BE
LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR
OTHER LIABILITY, INCLUDING ANY GENERAL,
SPECIAL, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL,
OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES, WHETHER IN AN
ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR
OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF THE USE OR
INABILITY TO USE THE FONT
SOFTWARE OR FROM OTHER DEALINGS IN THE
FONT SOFTWARE.
Except as contained in this notice, the names of
Gnome, the Gnome
Foundation, and Bitstream Inc., shall not be used in
advertising or
otherwise to promote the sale, use or other dealings
in this Font
Software without prior written authorization from the
Gnome Foundation
or Bitstream Inc., respectively. For further information,
contact:
fonts at gnome dot org.
Copyright FAQ
=============
1. I don't understand the resale restriction... What
gives?
Bitstream is giving away these fonts, but
wishes to ensure its
competitors can't just drop the fonts as is into
a font sale system
and sell them as is. It seems fair that if
Bitstream can't make money
from the Bitstream Vera fonts, their
competitors should not be able to
do so either. You can sell the fonts as part of
any software package,
however.
2. I want to package these fonts separately for
distribution and
sale as part of a larger software package or
system. Can I do so?
Yes. A RPM or Debian package is a "larger
software package" to begin
with, and you aren't selling them
independently by themselves.
See 1. above.
3. Are derivative works allowed?
Yes!
4. Can I change or add to the font(s)?
Yes, but you must change the name(s) of the
font(s).
5. Under what terms are derivative works allowed?
You must change the name(s) of the fonts.
This is to ensure the
quality of the fonts, both to protect Bitstream
and Gnome. We want to
ensure that if an application has opened a
font specifically of these
names, it gets what it expects (though of
course, using fontconfig,
substitutions could still could have occurred
during font
opening). You must include the Bitstream
copyright. Additional
copyrights can be added, as per copyright law.
Happy Font Hacking!
6. If I have improvements for Bitstream Vera, is it
possible they might get
adopted in future versions?
Yes. The contract between the Gnome
Foundation and Bitstream has
provisions for working with Bitstream to ensure
quality additions to
the Bitstream Vera font family. Please contact
us if you have such
59
additions. Note, that in general, we will want
such additions for the
entire family, not just a single font, and that
you'll have to keep
both Gnome and Jim Lyles, Vera's designer,
happy! To make sense to add
glyphs to the font, they must be stylistically in
keeping with Vera's
design. Vera cannot become a "ransom note"
font. Jim Lyles will be
providing a document describing the design
elements used in Vera, as a
guide and aid for people interested in
contributing to Vera.
7. I want to sell a software package that uses these
fonts: Can I do so?
Sure. Bundle the fonts with your software and
sell your software
with the fonts. That is the intent of the
copyright.
8. If applications have built the names "Bitstream
Vera" into them,
can I override this somehow to use fonts of my
choosing?
This depends on exact details of the software.
Most open source
systems and software (e.g., Gnome, KDE, etc.)
are now converting to
use fontconfig (see www.fontconfig.org ) to
handle font configuration,
selection and substitution; it has provisions for
overriding font
names and subsituting alternatives. An
example is provided by the
supplied local.conf file, which chooses the
family Bitstream Vera for
"sans", "serif" and "monospace". Other
software (e.g., the XFree86
core server) has other mechanisms for font
substitution.
Open Sans fonts
URL:
http://www.google.com/fonts/specimen/Open+Sans
License for Open Sans Font Family
--------------------------------
Apache License
Version 2.0,
January 2004
http://www.apache.org/licenses/
TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR USE,
REPRODUCTION, AND DISTRIBUTION
1. Definitions.
"License" shall mean the terms and conditions
for use, reproduction,
and distribution as defined by Sections 1
through 9 of this document.
"Licensor" shall mean the copyright owner or
entity authorized by
the copyright owner that is granting the
License.
"Legal Entity" shall mean the union of the
acting entity and all
other entities that control, are controlled by, or
are under common
control with that entity. For the purposes of
this definition,
"control" means (i) the power, direct or
indirect, to cause the
direction or management of such entity,
whether by contract or
otherwise, or (ii) ownership of fifty percent
(50%) or more of the
outstanding shares, or (iii) beneficial
ownership of such entity.
"You" (or "Your") shall mean an individual or
Legal Entity
exercising permissions granted by this License.
"Source" form shall mean the preferred form
for making modifications,
including but not limited to software source
code, documentation
source, and configuration files.
"Object" form shall mean any form resulting
from mechanical
transformation or translation of a Source form,
including but
not limited to compiled object code,
generated documentation,
60
and conversions to other media types.
"Work" shall mean the work of authorship,
whether in Source or
Object form, made available under the
License, as indicated by a
copyright notice that is included in or attached
to the work
(an example is provided in the Appendix
below).
"Derivative Works" shall mean any work,
whether in Source or Object
form, that is based on (or derived from) the
Work and for which the
editorial revisions, annotations, elaborations,
or other modifications
represent, as a whole, an original work of
authorship. For the purposes
of this License, Derivative Works shall not
include works that remain
separable from, or merely link (or bind by
name) to the interfaces of,
the Work and Derivative Works thereof.
"Contribution" shall mean any work of
authorship, including
the original version of the Work and any
modifications or additions
to that Work or Derivative Works thereof, that
is intentionally
submitted to Licensor for inclusion in the Work
by the copyright owner
or by an individual or Legal Entity authorized
to submit on behalf of
the copyright owner. For the purposes of this
definition, "submitted"
means any form of electronic, verbal, or
written communication sent
to the Licensor or its representatives, including
but not limited to
communication on electronic mailing lists,
source code control systems,
and issue tracking systems that are managed
by, or on behalf of, the
Licensor for the purpose of discussing and
improving the Work, but
excluding communication that is
conspicuously marked or otherwise
designated in writing by the copyright owner
as "Not a Contribution."
"Contributor" shall mean Licensor and any
individual or Legal Entity
on behalf of whom a Contribution has been
received by Licensor and
subsequently incorporated within the Work.
2. Grant of Copyright License. Subject to the terms
and conditions of
this License, each Contributor hereby grants to
You a perpetual,
worldwide, non-exclusive, no-charge, royalty-
free, irrevocable
copyright license to reproduce, prepare
Derivative Works of,
publicly display, publicly perform, sublicense,
and distribute the
Work and such Derivative Works in Source or
Object form.
3. Grant of Patent License. Subject to the terms
and conditions of
this License, each Contributor hereby grants to
You a perpetual,
worldwide, non-exclusive, no-charge, royalty-
free, irrevocable
(except as stated in this section) patent license
to make, have made,
use, offer to sell, sell, import, and otherwise
transfer the Work,
where such license applies only to those
patent claims licensable
by such Contributor that are necessarily
infringed by their
Contribution(s) alone or by combination of
their Contribution(s)
with the Work to which such Contribution(s)
was submitted. If You
institute patent litigation against any entity
(including a
cross-claim or counterclaim in a lawsuit)
alleging that the Work
or a Contribution incorporated within the Work
constitutes direct
or contributory patent infringement, then any
patent licenses
granted to You under this License for that
Work shall terminate
as of the date such litigation is filed.
61
4. Redistribution. You may reproduce and
distribute copies of the
Work or Derivative Works thereof in any
medium, with or without
modifications, and in Source or Object form,
provided that You
meet the following conditions:
(a) You must give any other recipients of the
Work or
Derivative Works a copy of this License;
and
(b) You must cause any modified files to carry
prominent notices
stating that You changed the files; and
(c) You must retain, in the Source form of any
Derivative Works
that You distribute, all copyright, patent,
trademark, and
attribution notices from the Source form
of the Work,
excluding those notices that do not
pertain to any part of
the Derivative Works; and
(d) If the Work includes a "NOTICE" text file as
part of its
distribution, then any Derivative Works
that You distribute must
include a readable copy of the
attribution notices contained
within such NOTICE file, excluding those
notices that do not
pertain to any part of the Derivative
Works, in at least one
of the following places: within a NOTICE
text file distributed
as part of the Derivative Works; within
the Source form or
documentation, if provided along with
the Derivative Works; or,
within a display generated by the
Derivative Works, if and
wherever such third-party notices
normally appear. The contents
of the NOTICE file are for informational
purposes only and
do not modify the License. You may add
Your own attribution
notices within Derivative Works that You
distribute, alongside
or as an addendum to the NOTICE text
from the Work, provided
that such additional attribution notices
cannot be construed
as modifying the License.
You may add Your own copyright statement to
Your modifications and
may provide additional or different license
terms and conditions
for use, reproduction, or distribution of Your
modifications, or
for any such Derivative Works as a whole,
provided Your use,
reproduction, and distribution of the Work
otherwise complies with
the conditions stated in this License.
5. Submission of Contributions. Unless You
explicitly state otherwise,
any Contribution intentionally submitted for
inclusion in the Work
by You to the Licensor shall be under the
terms and conditions of
this License, without any additional terms or
conditions.
Notwithstanding the above, nothing herein
shall supersede or modify
the terms of any separate license agreement
you may have executed
with Licensor regarding such Contributions.
6. Trademarks. This License does not grant
permission to use the trade
names, trademarks, service marks, or product
names of the Licensor,
except as required for reasonable and
customary use in describing the
origin of the Work and reproducing the
content of the NOTICE file.
7. Disclaimer of Warranty. Unless required by
applicable law or
agreed to in writing, Licensor provides the
Work (and each
62
Contributor provides its Contributions) on an
"AS IS" BASIS,
WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF
ANY KIND, either express or
implied, including, without limitation, any
warranties or conditions
of TITLE, NON-INFRINGEMENT,
MERCHANTABILITY, or FITNESS FOR A
PARTICULAR PURPOSE. You are solely
responsible for determining the
appropriateness of using or redistributing the
Work and assume any
risks associated with Your exercise of
permissions under this License.
8. Limitation of Liability. In no event and under no
legal theory,
whether in tort (including negligence),
contract, or otherwise,
unless required by applicable law (such as
deliberate and grossly
negligent acts) or agreed to in writing, shall
any Contributor be
liable to You for damages, including any
direct, indirect, special,
incidental, or consequential damages of any
character arising as a
result of this License or out of the use or
inability to use the
Work (including but not limited to damages for
loss of goodwill,
work stoppage, computer failure or
malfunction, or any and all
other commercial damages or losses), even if
such Contributor
has been advised of the possibility of such
damages.
9. Accepting Warranty or Additional Liability. While
redistributing
the Work or Derivative Works thereof, You may
choose to offer,
and charge a fee for, acceptance of support,
warranty, indemnity,
or other liability obligations and/or rights
consistent with this
License. However, in accepting such
obligations, You may act only
on Your own behalf and on Your sole
responsibility, not on behalf
of any other Contributor, and only if You agree
to indemnify,
defend, and hold each Contributor harmless
for any liability
incurred by, or claims asserted against, such
Contributor by reason
of your accepting any such warranty or
additional liability.
END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS
APPENDIX: How to apply the Apache License to
your work.
To apply the Apache License to your work,
attach the following
boilerplate notice, with the fields enclosed by
brackets "[]"
replaced with your own identifying
information. (Don't include
the brackets!) The text should be enclosed in
the appropriate
comment syntax for the file format. We also
recommend that a
file or class name and description of purpose
be included on the
same "printed page" as the copyright notice
for easier
identification within third-party archives.
Copyright [yyyy] [name of copyright owner]
Licensed under the Apache License, Version 2.0
(the "License");
you may not use this file except in compliance
with the License.
You may obtain a copy of the License at
http://www.apache.org/licenses/LICENSE-2.0
Unless required by applicable law or agreed to in
writing, software
distributed under the License is distributed on an
"AS IS" BASIS,
63
WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF ANY
KIND, either express or implied.
See the License for the specific language
governing permissions and
limitations under the License.
VL Gothic fonts
URL: http://dicey.org/vlgothic/index.html
License for VLGothic Font Family
--------------------------------
This font includes glyphs derived from M+ FONTS
which is created by
M+ FONTS PROJECT. License for M+ FONTS part is
described in M+ FONTS
PROJECT's license. See attached 'LICENSE_E.mplus'.
This font also includes glyphs derived from
Sazanami Gothic font which
is created by Electronic Font Open Laboratory
(/efont/). License for
Sazanami Gothic part is described in it's license. See
attached
'README.sazanami' for original Sazanami Gothic font
license.
This font also includes original glyphs which is
created by Daisuke
SUZUKI and Project Vine based on M+ FONTS. Licese
for VL Gothic
original glyphs is same as M+ FONTS PROJECT's
license.
There is no limitation and the below description is
not applied
as for in order not to reuse as font (ex: font is
embeded to documents).
Copyright (c) 1990-2003 Wada Laboratory, the
University of Tokyo.
Copyright (c) 2003-2004 Electronic Font Open
Laboratory (/efont/).
Copyright (C) 2003-2009 M+ FONTS PROJECT
Copyright (C) 2006-2009 Daisuke SUZUKI
<daisuke@vinelinux.org>.
Copyright (C) 2006-2009 Project Vine
<Vine@vinelinux.org>.
All rights reserved.
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms,
with or without
modification, are permitted provided that the
following conditions
are met:
this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
this list of conditions and the following disclaimer
in the documentation
and/or other materials provided with the
distribution.
the names of its contributors may be used to
endorse or promote products
derived from this software without specific prior
written permission.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY WADA
LABORATORY, THE UNIVERSITY OF TOKYO AND
CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR
IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT
NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A
PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO
EVENT SHALL THE LABORATORY OR
CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT,
INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL,
EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES
(INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,
PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR
SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS;
OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED
AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY,
WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR
TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR
OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE
OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF
ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
Nanum fonts
URL: http://hangeul.naver.com/
Copyright (c) 2010, NAVER Corporation (
http://www.nhncorp.com ).
with Reserved Font Name Nanum, Naver Nanum,
NanumGothic, Naver NanumGothic,
NanumMyeongjo, Naver NanumMyeongjo,
NanumBrush, Naver NanumBrush, NanumPen, Naver
NanumPen, Naver NanumGothicEco,
NanumGothicEco, Naver NanumMyeongjoEco,
NanumMyeongjoEco, Naver NanumGothicLight,
NanumGothicLight, NanumBarunGothic, Naver
NanumBarunGothic,
This Font Software is licensed under the SIL Open
64
Font License, Version 1.1.
This license is copied below, and is also available with
a FAQ at: http://scripts.sil.org/OFL
This Font Software is licensed under the SIL Open
Font License, Version 1.1.
This license is copied below, and is also available with
a FAQ at:
http://scripts.sil.org/OFL
-------------------------------------------------
----------
SIL OPEN FONT LICENSE Version 1.1 - 26 February
2007
-------------------------------------------------
----------
PREAMBLE
The goals of the Open Font License (OFL) are to
stimulate worldwide development of collaborative
font projects, to support the font creation efforts of
academic and linguistic communities, and to provide
a free and open framework in which fonts may be
shared and improved in partnership with others.
The OFL allows the licensed fonts to be used,
studied, modified and redistributed freely as long as
they are not sold by themselves. The fonts, including
any derivative works, can be bundled,
embedded, redistributed and/or sold with any
software provided that any reserved names are not
used by derivative works. The fonts and
derivatives, however, cannot be released under any
other type of license. The requirement for fonts to
remain under this license does not apply to any
document created using the fonts or their derivatives.
DEFINITIONS
"Font Software" refers to the set of files released by
the Copyright Holder(s) under this license and clearly
marked as such. This may include source files, build
scripts and documentation.
"Reserved Font Name" refers to any names specified
as such after the copyright statement(s).
"Original Version" refers to the collection of Font
Software components as distributed by the
Copyright Holder(s).
"Modified Version" refers to any derivative made by
adding to, deleting, or substituting -- in part or in
whole -- any of the components of the Original
Version, by changing formats or by porting the Font
Software to a new environment.
"Author" refers to any designer, engineer,
programmer, technical writer or other person who
contributed to the Font Software.
PERMISSION & CONDITIONS
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any
person obtaining
a copy of the Font Software, to use, study, copy,
merge, embed, modify,
redistribute, and sell modified and unmodified copies
of the Font
Software, subject to the following conditions:
1) Neither the Font Software nor any of its individual
components,
in Original or Modified Versions, may be sold by itself.
2) Original or Modified Versions of the Font Software
may be bundled,
redistributed and/or sold with any software, provided
that each copy
contains the above copyright notice and this license.
These can be
included either as stand-alone text files, human-
readable headers or
in the appropriate machine-readable metadata fields
within text or
binary files as long as those fields can be easily
viewed by the user.
3) No Modified Version of the Font Software may use
the Reserved Font
Name(s) unless explicit written permission is granted
by the corresponding
Copyright Holder. This restriction only applies to the
primary font name as
presented to the users.
4) The name(s) of the Copyright Holder(s) or the
Author(s) of the Font
Software shall not be used to promote, endorse or
advertise any
Modified Version, except to acknowledge the
contribution(s) of the
Copyright Holder(s) and the Author(s) or with their
explicit written
5) The Font Software, modified or unmodified, in part
or in whole,
must be distributed entirely under this license, and
must not be
65
distributed under any other license. The requirement
for fonts to
remain under this license does not apply to any
document created
using the Font Software.
TERMINATION
This license becomes null and void if any of the
above conditions are
not met.
DISCLAIMER
THE FONT SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS",
WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND,
EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT
LIMITED TO ANY WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT
OF COPYRIGHT, PATENT, TRADEMARK, OR OTHER
RIGHT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
COPYRIGHT HOLDER BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM,
DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY,
INCLUDING ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL, INDIRECT,
INCIDENTAL, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
DAMAGES, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT,
TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING
FROM, OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE
FONT SOFTWARE OR FROM
OTHER DEALINGS IN THE FONT SOFTWARE.
Mini-XML
URL: http://www.msweet.org/projects.php?Z3
Mini-XML License
The Mini-XML library and included programs are
provided under the terms of the GNU Library General
Public License version 2 (LGPL2) with the following
exceptions:
If you link the application to a modified version of
Mini-XML, then the changes to Mini-XML must be
provided under the terms of the LGPL2 in sections 1,
2, and 4.
GNU LIBRARY GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
Version 2, June 1991
Copyright (C) 1991 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
USA
Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim
copies of this license document, but changing it is not
allowed.
[This is the first released version of the library GPL. It
is numbered 2 because it goes with version 2 of the
ordinary GPL.]
Preamble
The licenses for most software are designed to take
away your freedom to share and change it. By
contrast, the GNU General Public Licenses are
intended to guarantee your freedom to share and
change free software--to make sure the software is
free for all its users.
This license, the Library General Public License,
applies to some specially designated Free Software
Foundation software, and to any other libraries
whose authors decide to use it. You can use it for
your libraries, too.
When we speak of free software, we are referring to
freedom, not price. Our General Public Licenses are
designed to make sure that you have the freedom to
distribute copies of free software (and charge for this
service if you wish), that you receive source code or
can get it if you want it, that you can change the
software or use pieces of it in new free programs; and
that you know you can do these things.
To protect your rights, we need to make restrictions
that forbid anyone to deny you these rights or to ask
you to surrender the rights. These restrictions
translate to certain responsibilities for you if you
distribute copies of the library, or if you modify it.
For example, if you distribute copies of the library,
whether gratis or for a fee, you must give the
recipients all the rights that we gave you. You must
make sure that they, too, receive or can get the
source code. If you link a program with the library,
you must provide complete object files to the
recipients so that they can relink them with the library,
after making changes to the library and recompiling it.
And you must show them these terms so they know
their rights.
Our method of protecting your rights has two steps:
(1) copyright the library, and (2) offer you this license
which gives you legal permission to copy, distribute
and/or modify the library.
Also, for each distributor's protection, we want to
make certain that everyone understands that there is
no warranty for this free library. If the library is
modified by someone else and passed on, we want
its recipients to know that what they have is not the
original version, so that any problems introduced by
others will not reflect on the original authors'
reputations.
66
Finally, any free program is threatened constantly by
software patents. We wish to avoid the danger that
companies distributing free software will individually
obtain patent licenses, thus in effect transforming the
program into proprietary software. To prevent this, we
have made it clear that any patent must be licensed
for everyone's free use or not licensed at all.
Most GNU software, including some libraries, is
covered by the ordinary GNU General Public License,
which was designed for utility programs. This license,
the GNU Library General Public License, applies to
certain designated libraries. This license is quite
different from the ordinary one; be sure to read it in
full, and don't assume that anything in it is the same
as in the ordinary license.
The reason we have a separate public license for
some libraries is that they blur the distinction we
usually make between modifying or adding to a
program and simply using it. Linking a program with a
library, without changing the library, is in some sense
simply using the library, and is analogous to running a
utility program or application program. However, in a
textual and legal sense, the linked executable is a
combined work, a derivative of the original library,
and the ordinary General Public License treats it as
such.
Because of this blurred distinction, using the ordinary
General Public License for libraries did not effectively
promote software sharing, because most developers
did not use the libraries. We concluded that weaker
conditions might promote sharing better.
However, unrestricted linking of non-free programs
would deprive the users of those programs of all
benefit from the free status of the libraries
themselves. This Library General Public License is
intended to permit developers of non-free programs
to use free libraries, while preserving your freedom as
a user of such programs to change the free libraries
that are incorporated in them. (We have not seen how
to achieve this as regards changes in header files, but
we have achieved it as regards changes in the actual
functions of the Library.) The hope is that this will lead
to faster development of free libraries.
The precise terms and conditions for copying,
distribution and modification follow. Pay close
attention to the difference between a "work based on
the libary" and a "work that uses the library". The
former contains code derived from the library, while
the latter only works together with the library.
Note that it is possible for a library to be covered by
the ordinary General Public License rather than by
this special one.
TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR COPYING,
DISTRIBUTION AND MODIFICATION
A "library" means a collection of software functions
and/or data prepared so as to be conveniently linked
with application programs (which use some of those
functions and data) to form executables.
The "Library", below, refers to any such software
library or work which has been distributed under
these terms. A "work based on the Library" means
either the Library or any derivative work under
copyright law: that is to say, a work containing the
Library or a portion of it, either verbatim or with
modifications and/or translated straightforwardly into
another language. (Hereinafter, translation is included
without limitation in the term "modification".)
"Source code" for a work means the preferred form of
the work for making modifications to it. For a library,
complete source code means all the source code for
all modules it contains, plus any associated interface
definition files, plus the scripts used to control
compilation and installation of the library.
Activities other than copying, distribution and
modification are not covered by this License; they are
outside its scope. The act of running a program using
the Library is not restricted, and output from such a
program is covered only if its contents constitute a
work based on the Library (independent of the use of
the Library in a tool for writing it). Whether that is true
depends on what the Library does and what the
program that uses the Library does.
You may charge a fee for the physical act of
transferring a copy, and you may at your option offer
warranty protection in exchange for a fee.
a) The modified work must itself be a software library.
b) You must cause the files modified to carry
prominent notices stating that you changed the files
and the date of any change.
c) You must cause the whole of the work to be
licensed at no charge to all third parties under the
terms of this License.
d) If a facility in the modified Library refers to a
function or a table of data to be supplied by an
application program that uses the facility, other than
as an argument passed when the facility is invoked,
then you must make a good faith effort to ensure that,
in the event an application does not supply such
function or table, the facility still operates, and
performs whatever part of its purpose remains
meaningful.
(For example, a function in a library to compute
square roots has a purpose that is entirely well-
defined independent of the application. Therefore,
Subsection 2d requires that any application-supplied
function or table used by this function must be
optional: if the application does not supply it, the
square root function must still compute square roots.)
These requirements apply to the modified work as a
whole. If identifiable sections of that work are not
67
derived from the Library, and can be reasonably
considered independent and separate works in
themselves, then this License, and its terms, do not
apply to those sections when you distribute them as
separate works. But when you distribute the same
sections as part of a whole which is a work based on
the Library, the distribution of the whole must be on
the terms of this License, whose permissions for other
licensees extend to the entire whole, and thus to
each and every part regardless of who wrote it.
Thus, it is not the intent of this section to claim rights
or contest your rights to work written entirely by you;
rather, the intent is to exercise the right to control the
distribution of derivative or collective works based on
the Library.
In addition, mere aggregation of another work not
based on the Library with the Library (or with a work
based on the Library) on a volume of a storage or
distribution medium does not bring the other work
under the scope of this License.
Once this change is made in a given copy, it is
irreversible for that copy, so the ordinary GNU
General Public License applies to all subsequent
copies and derivative works made from that copy.
This option is useful when you wish to copy part of
the code of the Library into a program that is not a
library.
If distribution of object code is made by offering
access to copy from a designated place, then offering
equivalent access to copy the source code from the
same place satisfies the requirement to distribute the
source code, even though third parties are not
compelled to copy the source along with the object
code.
However, linking a "work that uses the Library" with
the Library creates an executable that is a derivative
of the Library (because it contains portions of the
Library), rather than a "work that uses the library". The
executable is therefore covered by this License.
Section 6 states terms for distribution of such
executables.
When a "work that uses the Library" uses material
from a header file that is part of the Library, the object
code for the work may be a derivative work of the
Library even though the source code is not. Whether
this is true is especially significant if the work can be
linked without the Library, or if the work is itself a
library. The threshold for this to be true is not
precisely defined by law.
If such an object file uses only numerical parameters,
data structure layouts and accessors, and small
macros and small inline functions (ten lines or less in
length), then the use of the object file is unrestricted,
regardless of whether it is legally a derivative work.
(Executables containing this object code plus
portions of the Library will still fall under Section 6.)
Otherwise, if the work is a derivative of the Library,
you may distribute the object code for the work under
the terms of Section 6. Any executables containing
that work also fall under Section 6, whether or not
they are linked directly with the Library itself.
You must give prominent notice with each copy of the
work that the Library is used in it and that the Library
and its use are covered by this License. You must
supply a copy of this License. If the work during
execution displays copyright notices, you must
include the copyright notice for the Library among
them, as well as a reference directing the user to the
copy of this License. Also, you must do one of these
things:
a) Accompany the work with the complete
corresponding machine-readable source code for the
Library including whatever changes were used in the
work (which must be distributed under Sections 1 and
2 above); and, if the work is an executable linked with
the Library, with the complete machine-readable
"work that uses the Library", as object code and/or
source code, so that the user can modify the Library
and then relink to produce a modified executable
containing the modified Library. (It is understood that
the user who changes the contents of definitions files
in the Library will not necessarily be able to recompile
the application to use the modified definitions.)
b) Accompany the work with a written offer, valid for
at least three years, to give the same user the
materials specified in Subsection 6a, above, for a
charge no more than the cost of performing this
distribution.
c) If distribution of the work is made by offering
access to copy from a designated place, offer
equivalent access to copy the above specified
materials from the same place.
d) Verify that the user has already received a copy of
these materials or that you have already sent this user
a copy.
For an executable, the required form of the "work that
uses the Library" must include any data and utility
programs needed for reproducing the executable
from it. However, as a special exception, the source
code distributed need not include anything that is
normally distributed (in either source or binary form)
with the major components (compiler, kernel, and so
on) of the operating system on which the executable
runs, unless that component itself accompanies the
executable.
It may happen that this requirement contradicts the
license restrictions of other proprietary libraries that
do not normally accompany the operating system.
Such a contradiction means you cannot use both
them and the Library together in an executable that
you distribute.
a) Accompany the combined library with a copy of
68
the same work based on the Library, uncombined
with any other library facilities. This must be
distributed under the terms of the Sections above.
b) Give prominent notice with the combined library of
the fact that part of it is a work based on the Library,
and explaining where to find the accompanying
uncombined form of the same work.
If any portion of this section is held invalid or
unenforceable under any particular circumstance, the
balance of the section is intended to apply, and the
section as a whole is intended to apply in other
circumstances.
It is not the purpose of this section to induce you to
infringe any patents or other property right claims or
to contest validity of any such claims; this section has
the sole purpose of protecting the integrity of the free
software distribution system which is implemented by
public license practices. Many people have made
generous contributions to the wide range of software
distributed through that system in reliance on
consistent application of that system; it is up to the
author/donor to decide if he or she is willing to
distribute software through any other system and a
licensee cannot impose that choice.
This section is intended to make thoroughly clear
what is believed to be a consequence of the rest of
this License.
Each version is given a distinguishing version number.
If the Library specifies a version number of this
License which applies to it and "any later version",
you have the option of following the terms and
conditions either of that version or of any later version
published by the Free Software Foundation. If the
Library does not specify a license version number,
you may choose any version ever published by the
Free Software Foundation.
NO WARRANTY
END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS
How to Apply These Terms to Your New Libraries
If you develop a new library, and you want it to be of
the greatest possible use to the public, we
recommend making it free software that everyone
can redistribute and change. You can do so by
permitting redistribution under these terms (or,
alternatively, under the terms of the ordinary General
Public License).
To apply these terms, attach the following notices to
the library. It is safest to attach them to the start of
each source file to most effectively convey the
exclusion of warranty; and each file should have at
least the "copyright" line and a pointer to where the
full notice is found.
one line to give the library's name and an idea of
what it does.
Copyright (C) year name of author
This library is free software; you can redistribute it
and/or modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser
General Public License as published by the Free
Software Foundation; either version 2.1 of the License,
or (at your option) any later version.
This library is distributed in the hope that it will be
useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even
the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
Lesser General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser
General Public License along with this library; if not,
write to the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59
Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA
Also add information on how to contact you by
electronic and paper mail.
You should also get your employer (if you work as a
programmer) or your school, if any, to sign a
"copyright disclaimer" for the library, if necessary.
Here is a sample; alter the names:
Yoyodyne, Inc., hereby disclaims all copyright interest
in the library `Frob' (a library for tweaking knobs)
written by James Random Hacker.
signature of Ty Coon, 1 April 1990 Ty Coon, President
of Vice
That's all there is to it!
Boost
URL: http://www.boost.org/
Boost Software License - Version 1.0 - August 17th,
2003
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any
person or organization
obtaining a copy of the software and accompanying
documentation covered by
this license (the "Software") to use, reproduce,
display, distribute,
execute, and transmit the Software, and to prepare
derivative works of the
Software, and to permit third-parties to whom the
Software is furnished to
do so, all subject to the following:
The copyright notices in the Software and this entire
statement, including
69
the above license grant, this restriction and the
following disclaimer,
must be included in all copies of the Software, in
whole or in part, and
all derivative works of the Software, unless such
copies or derivative
works are solely in the form of machine-executable
object code generated by
a source language processor.
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT
WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR
IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY,
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, TITLE AND
NON-INFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT
SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS OR ANYONE
DISTRIBUTING THE SOFTWARE BE LIABLE
FOR ANY DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY,
WHETHER IN CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE,
ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH
THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER
DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE.
libcurl
URL: http://curl.haxx.se/
COPYRIGHT AND PERMISSION NOTICE
Copyright (c) 1996 - 2014, Daniel Stenberg,
<daniel@haxx.se>.
All rights reserved.
Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this
software for any purpose
with or without fee is hereby granted, provided that
the above copyright
notice and this permission notice appear in all copies.
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT
WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR
IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY,
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND
NONINFRINGEMENT OF THIRD PARTY RIGHTS. IN
NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT
HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM,
DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN
ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR
OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN
CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE
OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE.
Except as contained in this notice, the name of a
copyright holder shall not
be used in advertising or otherwise to promote the
sale, use or other dealings
in this Software without prior written authorization of
the copyright holder.
libcurl - lib/krb5.c
URL:
https://github.com/bagder/curl/blob/master/lib/krb5
.c
/* GSSAPI/krb5 support for FTP - loosely based on
old krb4.c
*
* Copyright (c) 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2013
Kungliga Tekniska Högskolan
* (Royal Institute of Technology, Stockholm,
Sweden).
* Copyright (c) 2004 - 2012 Daniel Stenberg
* All rights reserved.
*
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms,
with or without
* modification, are permitted provided that the
following conditions
* are met:
*
* 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the
above copyright
* notice, this list of conditions and the following
disclaimer.
*
* 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce
the above copyright
* notice, this list of conditions and the following
disclaimer in the
* documentation and/or other materials
provided with the distribution.
*
* 3. Neither the name of the Institute nor the names
of its contributors
* may be used to endorse or promote products
derived from this software
* without specific prior written permission.
*
* THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE INSTITUTE
70
AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
* ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES,
INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
* IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
* ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
INSTITUTE OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
* FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL,
SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
* DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,
PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
* OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS;
OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
* HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF
LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
* LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR
OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
* OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF
ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
* SUCH DAMAGE. */
libcurl - lib/security.c
URL:
https://github.com/bagder/curl/blob/master/lib/secu
rity.c
/* This source code was modified by Martin
Hedenfalk <mhe@stacken.kth.se> for
* use in Curl. His latest changes were done
2000-09-18.
*
* It has since been patched and modified a lot by
Daniel Stenberg
* <daniel@haxx.se> to make it better applied to curl
conditions, and to make
* it not use globals, pollute name space and more.
This source code awaits a
* rewrite to work around the paragraph 2 in the BSD
licenses as explained
* below.
*
* Copyright (c) 1998, 1999, 2013 Kungliga Tekniska
Högskolan
* (Royal Institute of Technology, Stockholm,
Sweden).
*
* Copyright (C) 2001 - 2013, Daniel Stenberg,
<daniel@haxx.se>, et al.
*
* All rights reserved.
*
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms,
with or without
* modification, are permitted provided that the
following conditions
* are met:
*
* 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the
above copyright
* notice, this list of conditions and the following
disclaimer.
*
* 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce
the above copyright
* notice, this list of conditions and the following
disclaimer in the
* documentation and/or other materials
provided with the distribution.
*
* 3. Neither the name of the Institute nor the names
of its contributors
* may be used to endorse or promote products
derived from this software
* without specific prior written permission.
*
* THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE INSTITUTE
AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
* ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES,
INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
* IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
* ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
INSTITUTE OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
* FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL,
SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
* DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,
PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
* OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS;
OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
* HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF
LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
* LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR
OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
* OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF
ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
71
* SUCH DAMAGE. */
David M. Gay's floating point routines
URL: http://www.netlib.org/fp/
/*********************************************************
*******
*
* The author of this software is David M. Gay.
*
* Copyright (c) 1991, 2000, 2001 by Lucent
Technologies.
*
* Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this
software for any
* purpose without fee is hereby granted, provided
that this entire notice
* is included in all copies of any software which is or
includes a copy
* or modification of this software and in all copies of
the supporting
* documentation for such software.
*
* THIS SOFTWARE IS BEING PROVIDED "AS IS",
WITHOUT ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED
* WARRANTY. IN PARTICULAR, NEITHER THE
AUTHOR NOR LUCENT MAKES ANY
* REPRESENTATION OR WARRANTY OF ANY KIND
CONCERNING THE MERCHANTABILITY
* OF THIS SOFTWARE OR ITS FITNESS FOR ANY
PARTICULAR PURPOSE.
*
********************************************************
*******/
dynamic annotations
URL: http://code.google.com/p/data-race-
test/wiki/DynamicAnnotations
/* Copyright (c) 2008-2009, Google Inc.
* All rights reserved.
*
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms,
with or without
* modification, are permitted provided that the
following conditions are
* met:
*
* * Redistributions of source code must retain
the above copyright
* notice, this list of conditions and the following
disclaimer.
* * Neither the name of Google Inc. nor the
names of its
* contributors may be used to endorse or promote
products derived from
* this software without specific prior written
permission.
*
* THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE
COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS
* "AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED
WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
* LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR
* A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN
NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT
* OWNER OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY
DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL,
* SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT
* LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE
GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE,
* DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS
INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY
* THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT,
STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT
* (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE)
ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE
* OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
*
* ---
* Author: Kostya Serebryany
*/
libevent
URL: http://libevent.org/
Libevent is available for use under the following
license, commonly known
as the 3-clause (or "modified") BSD license:
==============================
Copyright (c) 2000-2007 Niels Provos
<provos@citi.umich.edu>
72
Copyright (c) 2007-2010 Niels Provos and Nick
Mathewson
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms,
with or without
modification, are permitted provided that the
following conditions
are met:
notice, this list of conditions and the following
disclaimer.
notice, this list of conditions and the following
disclaimer in the
documentation and/or other materials provided
with the distribution.
derived from this software without specific prior
written permission.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR ``AS
IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR
IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES
OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A
PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED.
IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR
ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT,
INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT
NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE
GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE,
DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY
THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT,
STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT
(INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING
IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF
THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
==============================
Portions of Libevent are based on works by others,
also made available by
them under the three-clause BSD license above.
The copyright notices are
available in the corresponding source files; the license
is as above. Here's
a list:
Copyright (c) 2000 Dug Song
<dugsong@monkey.org>
Copyright (c) 1993 The Regents of the University of
California.
Copyright (c) 1998 Todd C. Miller
<Todd.Miller@courtesan.com>
Copyright (c) 2003 Michael A. Davis
<mike@datanerds.net>
Copyright (c) 2007 Sun Microsystems
Copyright (c) 2006 Maxim Yegorushkin
<maxim.yegorushkin@gmail.com>
Copyright 2002 Niels Provos
<provos@citi.umich.edu>
Netscape Portable Runtime (NSPR)
URL: http://www.mozilla.org/projects/nspr/
/* ***** BEGIN LICENSE BLOCK *****
* Version: MPL 1.1/GPL 2.0/LGPL 2.1
*
* The contents of this file are subject to the Mozilla
Public License Version
* 1.1 (the "License"); you may not use this file except
in compliance with
* the License. You may obtain a copy of the License
at
* http://www.mozilla.org/MPL/
*
* Software distributed under the License is
distributed on an "AS IS" basis,
* WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, either
express or implied. See the License
* for the specific language governing rights and
limitations under the
* License.
*
* The Original Code is the Netscape Portable
Runtime (NSPR).
*
* The Initial Developer of the Original Code is
* Netscape Communications Corporation.
* Portions created by the Initial Developer are
Copyright (C) 1998-2000
* the Initial Developer. All Rights Reserved.
*
* Contributor(s):
*
73
* Alternatively, the contents of this file may be used
under the terms of
* either the GNU General Public License Version 2 or
later (the "GPL"), or
* the GNU Lesser General Public License Version 2.1
or later (the "LGPL"),
* in which case the provisions of the GPL or the
LGPL are applicable instead
* of those above. If you wish to allow use of your
version of this file only
* under the terms of either the GPL or the LGPL, and
not to allow others to
* use your version of this file under the terms of the
MPL, indicate your
* decision by deleting the provisions above and
replace them with the notice
* and other provisions required by the GPL or the
LGPL. If you do not delete
* the provisions above, a recipient may use your
version of this file under
* the terms of any one of the MPL, the GPL or the
LGPL.
*
* ***** END LICENSE BLOCK ***** */
Paul Hsieh's SuperFastHash
URL:
http://www.azillionmonkeys.com/qed/hash.html
Paul Hsieh OLD BSD license
Copyright (c) 2010, Paul Hsieh
All rights reserved.
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms,
with or without modification,
are permitted provided that the following conditions
are met:
* Redistributions of source code must retain the
above copyright notice, this
list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
* Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the
above copyright notice, this
list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
documentation and/or
other materials provided with the distribution.
* Neither my name, Paul Hsieh, nor the names of any
other contributors to the
code use may not be used to endorse or promote
products derived from this
software without specific prior written permission.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT
HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS "AS IS" AND
ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES,
INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS
FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE
ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL,
EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES
(INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT
OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES;
LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS
INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON
ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN
CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT
(INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING
IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS
SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY
OF SUCH DAMAGE.
google-glog's symbolization library
URL: https://github.com/google/glog
Copyright (c) 2006, Google Inc.
All rights reserved.
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms,
with or without modification, are permitted provided
that the following conditions are met:
* Redistributions of source code must retain the
above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the
following disclaimer.
* Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the
above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the
following disclaimer in the documentation and/or
other materials provided with the distribution.
* Neither the name of Google Inc. nor the names of
its contributors may be used to endorse or promote
products derived from this software without specific
prior written permission.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT
HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS
"AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED
WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR
74
A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO
EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT
OWNER OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY
DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL,
SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT
LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE
GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE,
DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY
THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT,
STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT
(INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING
IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE
OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
valgrind
URL: http://valgrind.org
Notice that the following BSD-style license applies
to the Valgrind header
files used by Chromium (valgrind.h and
memcheck.h). However, the rest of
Valgrind is licensed under the terms of the GNU
General Public License,
version 2, unless otherwise indicated.
----------------------------------------------
------------------
Copyright (C) 2000-2008 Julian Seward. All
rights reserved.
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms,
with or without
modification, are permitted provided that the
following conditions
are met:
1. Redistributions of source code must retain the
above copyright
notice, this list of conditions and the following
disclaimer.
2. The origin of this software must not be
misrepresented; you must
not claim that you wrote the original
software. If you use this
software in a product, an acknowledgment in
the product
documentation would be appreciated but is
not required.
3. Altered source versions must be plainly marked
as such, and must
not be misrepresented as being the original
software.
4. The name of the author may not be used to
endorse or promote
products derived from this software without
specific prior written
permission.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR
``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS
OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR ANY
DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL,
EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,
PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE
GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR
PROFITS; OR BUSINESS
INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON
ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY,
WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR
TORT (INCLUDING
NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY
WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS
SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
Mozilla Personal Security Manager
URL: http://mxr.mozilla.org/mozilla-
central/source/security/manager/
/* ***** BEGIN LICENSE BLOCK *****
* Version: MPL 1.1/GPL 2.0/LGPL 2.1
*
* The contents of this file are subject to the Mozilla
Public License Version
* 1.1 (the "License"); you may not use this file except
in compliance with
75
* the License. You may obtain a copy of the License
at
* http://www.mozilla.org/MPL/
*
* Software distributed under the License is
distributed on an "AS IS" basis,
* WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, either
express or implied. See the License
* for the specific language governing rights and
limitations under the
* License.
*
* The Original Code is the Netscape security libraries.
*
* The Initial Developer of the Original Code is
* Netscape Communications Corporation.
* Portions created by the Initial Developer are
Copyright (C) 2000
* the Initial Developer. All Rights Reserved.
*
* Contributor(s):
*
* Alternatively, the contents of this file may be used
under the terms of
* either the GNU General Public License Version 2 or
later (the "GPL"), or
* the GNU Lesser General Public License Version 2.1
or later (the "LGPL"),
* in which case the provisions of the GPL or the
LGPL are applicable instead
* of those above. If you wish to allow use of your
version of this file only
* under the terms of either the GPL or the LGPL, and
not to allow others to
* use your version of this file under the terms of the
MPL, indicate your
* decision by deleting the provisions above and
replace them with the notice
* and other provisions required by the GPL or the
LGPL. If you do not delete
* the provisions above, a recipient may use your
version of this file under
* the terms of any one of the MPL, the GPL or the
LGPL.
*
* ***** END LICENSE BLOCK ***** */
Network Security Services (NSS)
URL:
http://www.mozilla.org/projects/security/pki/nss/
/* ***** BEGIN LICENSE BLOCK *****
* Version: MPL 1.1/GPL 2.0/LGPL 2.1
*
* The contents of this file are subject to the Mozilla
Public License Version
* 1.1 (the "License"); you may not use this file except
in compliance with
* the License. You may obtain a copy of the License
at
* http://www.mozilla.org/MPL/
*
* Software distributed under the License is
distributed on an "AS IS" basis,
* WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, either
express or implied. See the License
* for the specific language governing rights and
limitations under the
* License.
*
* The Original Code is the Netscape security libraries.
*
* The Initial Developer of the Original Code is
* Netscape Communications Corporation.
* Portions created by the Initial Developer are
Copyright (C) 1994-2000
* the Initial Developer. All Rights Reserved.
*
* Contributor(s):
*
* Alternatively, the contents of this file may be used
under the terms of
* either the GNU General Public License Version 2 or
later (the "GPL"), or
* the GNU Lesser General Public License Version 2.1
or later (the "LGPL"),
* in which case the provisions of the GPL or the
LGPL are applicable instead
* of those above. If you wish to allow use of your
version of this file only
* under the terms of either the GPL or the LGPL, and
not to allow others to
76
* use your version of this file under the terms of the
MPL, indicate your
* decision by deleting the provisions above and
replace them with the notice
* and other provisions required by the GPL or the
LGPL. If you do not delete
* the provisions above, a recipient may use your
version of this file under
* the terms of any one of the MPL, the GPL or the
LGPL.
*
* ***** END LICENSE BLOCK ***** */
open-vcdiff
URL: https://github.com/google/open-vcdiff
Almost Native Graphics Layer Engine
URL: http://code.google.com/p/angleproject/
Copyright (C) 2002-2013 The ANGLE Project Authors.
All rights reserved.
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms,
with or without modification, are permitted provided
that the following conditions are met:
Redistributions of source code must retain the above
copyright notice, this list of conditions and the
following disclaimer.
Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the
above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the
following disclaimer in the documentation and/or
other materials provided with the distribution.
Neither the name of TransGaming Inc., Google Inc.,
3DLabs Inc. Ltd., nor the names of their contributors
may be used to endorse or promote products
derived from this software without specific prior
written permission.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT
HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS
"AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED
WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS
FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN
NO EVENT SHALL THE
COPYRIGHT OWNER OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT,
INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING,
BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF
SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES;
LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS
INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER
CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY,
WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR
OTHERWISE) ARISING IN
ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE,
EVEN IF ADVISED OF THEPOSSIBILITY OF SUCH
DAMAGE.
boringssl
URL: https://boringssl.googlesource.com/boringssl
LICENSE ISSUES
==============
The OpenSSL toolkit stays under a dual license, i.e.
both the conditions of
the OpenSSL License and the original SSLeay
license apply to the toolkit.
See below for the actual license texts. Actually both
licenses are BSD-style
Open Source licenses. In case of any license issues
related to OpenSSL
please contact openssl-core@openssl.org.
OpenSSL License
---------------
/* ==============================================
======================
* Copyright (c) 1998-2011 The OpenSSL Project. All
rights reserved.
*
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms,
with or without
* modification, are permitted provided that the
following conditions
* are met:
*
* 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the
above copyright
* notice, this list of conditions and the following
disclaimer.
*
77
* 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce
the above copyright
* notice, this list of conditions and the following
disclaimer in
* the documentation and/or other materials
provided with the
* distribution.
*
* 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or
use of this
* software must display the following
acknowledgment:
* "This product includes software developed by
the OpenSSL Project
* for use in the OpenSSL Toolkit. (
http://www.openssl.org/
)"
*
* 4. The names "OpenSSL Toolkit" and "OpenSSL
Project" must not be used to
* endorse or promote products derived from this
software without
* prior written permission. For written
permission, please contact
* openssl-core@openssl.org.
*
* 5. Products derived from this software may not be
called "OpenSSL"
* nor may "OpenSSL" appear in their names
without prior written
* permission of the OpenSSL Project.
*
* 6. Redistributions of any form whatsoever must
retain the following
* acknowledgment:
* "This product includes software developed by
the OpenSSL Project
* for use in the OpenSSL Toolkit (
http://www.openssl.org/
)"
*
* THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE OpenSSL
PROJECT ``AS IS'' AND ANY
* EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES,
INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
* IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
* PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT
SHALL THE OpenSSL PROJECT OR
* ITS CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT,
INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL,
* SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT
* NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF
SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES;
* LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS
INTERRUPTION)
* HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF
LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT,
* STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING
NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE)
* ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS
SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED
* OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
* ==============================================
======================
*
* This product includes cryptographic software
written by Eric Young
* (eay@cryptsoft.com). This product includes
software written by Tim
* Hudson (tjh@cryptsoft.com).
*
*/
Original SSLeay License
-----------------------
/* Copyright (C) 1995-1998 Eric Young
(eay@cryptsoft.com)
* All rights reserved.
*
* This package is an SSL implementation written
* by Eric Young (eay@cryptsoft.com).
* The implementation was written so as to conform
with Netscapes SSL.
*
* This library is free for commercial and non-
commercial use as long as
* the following conditions are aheared to. The
following conditions
* apply to all code found in this distribution, be it the
RC4, RSA,
* lhash, DES, etc., code; not just the SSL code. The
SSL documentation
78
* included with this distribution is covered by the
same copyright terms
* except that the holder is Tim Hudson
(tjh@cryptsoft.com).
*
* Copyright remains Eric Young's, and as such any
Copyright notices in
* the code are not to be removed.
* If this package is used in a product, Eric Young
should be given attribution
* as the author of the parts of the library used.
* This can be in the form of a textual message at
program startup or
* in documentation (online or textual) provided with
the package.
*
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms,
with or without
* modification, are permitted provided that the
following conditions
* are met:
* 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the
copyright
* notice, this list of conditions and the following
disclaimer.
* 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce
the above copyright
* notice, this list of conditions and the following
disclaimer in the
* documentation and/or other materials
provided with the distribution.
* 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or
use of this software
* must display the following acknowledgement:
* "This product includes cryptographic software
written by
* Eric Young (eay@cryptsoft.com)"
* The word 'cryptographic' can be left out if the
rouines from the library
* being used are not cryptographic related :-).
* 4. If you include any Windows specific code (or a
derivative thereof) from
* the apps directory (application code) you must
include an acknowledgement:
* "This product includes software written by Tim
Hudson (tjh@cryptsoft.com)"
*
* THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY ERIC YOUNG
``AS IS'' AND
* ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES,
INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
* IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
* ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
AUTHOR OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
* FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL,
SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
* DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,
PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
* OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS;
OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
* HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF
LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
* LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR
OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
* OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF
ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
* SUCH DAMAGE.
*
* The licence and distribution terms for any
publically available version or
* derivative of this code cannot be changed. i.e. this
code cannot simply be
* copied and put under another distribution licence
* [including the GNU Public Licence.]
*/
Brotli
URL: https://github.com/google/brotli
Google Cache Invalidation API
URL:
https://chromium.googlesource.com/chromium/src/+
/master/third_party/cacheinvalidation/README.chro
mium
Crashpad
URL: https://crashpad.chromium.org/
drawElements Quality Program
URL:
https://source.android.com/devices/graphics/testing.
html
79
dom-distiller-js
URL: https://github.com/chromium/dom-distiller
Copyright 2014 The Chromium Authors. All rights
reserved.
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms,
with or without
modification, are permitted provided that the
following conditions are
met:
* Redistributions of source code must retain the
above copyright
notice, this list of conditions and the following
disclaimer.
* Redistributions in binary form must reproduce
the above
copyright notice, this list of conditions and the
following disclaimer
in the documentation and/or other materials provided
with the
* Neither the name of Google Inc. nor the names
of its
contributors may be used to endorse or promote
products derived from
this software without specific prior written permission.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT
HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS
"AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED
WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR
A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO
EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT
OWNER OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY
DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL,
SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT
LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE
GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE,
DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY
THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT,
STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT
(INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING
IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE
OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
Parts of the following directories are available under
Apache v2.0
src/de
Copyright (c) 2009-2011 Christian Kohlschütter
third_party/gwt_exporter
Copyright 2007 Timepedia.org
third_party/gwt-2.5.1
Copyright 2008 Google
java/org/chromium/distiller/dev
Copyright 2008 Google
Apache License
Version 2.0, January 2004
http://www.apache.org/licenses/
TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR USE,
REPRODUCTION, AND DISTRIBUTION
"License" shall mean the terms and conditions for
use, reproduction, and distribution as defined by
Sections 1 through 9 of this document.
"Licensor" shall mean the copyright owner or entity
authorized by the copyright owner that is granting the
License.
"Legal Entity" shall mean the union of the acting
entity and all other entities that control, are controlled
by, or are under common control with that entity. For
the purposes of this definition, "control" means (i) the
power, direct or indirect, to cause the direction or
management of such entity, whether by contract or
otherwise, or (ii) ownership of fifty percent (50%) or
more of the outstanding shares, or (iii) beneficial
80
ownership of such entity.
"You" (or "Your") shall mean an individual or Legal
Entity exercising permissions granted by this License.
"Source" form shall mean the preferred form for
making modifications, including but not limited to
software source code, documentation source, and
configuration files.
"Object" form shall mean any form resulting from
mechanical transformation or translation of a Source
form, including but not limited to compiled object
code, generated documentation, and conversions to
other media types.
"Work" shall mean the work of authorship, whether in
Source or Object form, made available under the
License, as indicated by a copyright notice that is
included in or attached to the work (an example is
provided in the Appendix below).
"Derivative Works" shall mean any work, whether in
Source or Object form, that is based on (or derived
from) the Work and for which the editorial revisions,
annotations, elaborations, or other modifications
represent, as a whole, an original work of authorship.
For the purposes of this License, Derivative Works
shall not include works that remain separable from, or
merely link (or bind by name) to the interfaces of, the
Work and Derivative Works thereof.
"Contribution" shall mean any work of authorship,
including the original version of the Work and any
modifications or additions to that Work or Derivative
Works thereof, that is intentionally submitted to
Licensor for inclusion in the Work by the copyright
owner or by an individual or Legal Entity authorized
to submit on behalf of the copyright owner. For the
purposes of this definition, "submitted" means any
form of electronic, verbal, or written communication
sent to the Licensor or its representatives, including
but not limited to communication on electronic
mailing lists, source code control systems, and issue
tracking systems that are managed by, or on behalf
of, the Licensor for the purpose of discussing and
improving the Work, but excluding communication
that is conspicuously marked or otherwise designated
in writing by the copyright owner as "Not a
Contribution."
"Contributor" shall mean Licensor and any individual
or Legal Entity on behalf of whom a Contribution has
been received by Licensor and subsequently
incorporated within the Work.
You must give any other recipients of the Work or
Derivative Works a copy of this License; and
You must cause any modified files to carry prominent
notices stating that You changed the files; and
You must retain, in the Source form of any Derivative
Works that You distribute, all copyright, patent,
trademark, and attribution notices from the Source
form of the Work, excluding those notices that do not
pertain to any part of the Derivative Works; and
If the Work includes a "NOTICE" text file as part of its
distribution, then any Derivative Works that You
distribute must include a readable copy of the
attribution notices contained within such NOTICE file,
excluding those notices that do not pertain to any
part of the Derivative Works, in at least one of the
following places: within a NOTICE text file distributed
as part of the Derivative Works; within the Source
form or documentation, if provided along with the
Derivative Works; or, within a display generated by
the Derivative Works, if and wherever such third-party
notices normally appear. The contents of the NOTICE
file are for informational purposes only and do not
modify the License. You may add Your own
attribution notices within Derivative Works that You
distribute, alongside or as an addendum to the
NOTICE text from the Work, provided that such
additional attribution notices cannot be construed as
modifying the License.
You may add Your own copyright statement to Your
modifications and may provide additional or different
license terms and conditions for use, reproduction, or
distribution of Your modifications, or for any such
Derivative Works as a whole, provided Your use,
reproduction, and distribution of the Work otherwise
complies with the conditions stated in this License.
END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS
Expat XML Parser
URL: http://sourceforge.net/projects/expat/
Copyright (c) 1998, 1999, 2000 Thai Open Source
Software Center Ltd
and Clark
Cooper
Copyright (c) 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006
Expat maintainers.
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any
person obtaining
81
a copy of this software and associated
documentation files (the
"Software"), to deal in the Software without
restriction, including
without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify,
merge, publish,
distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the
Software, and to
permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to
do so, subject to
the following conditions:
The above copyright notice and this permission
notice shall be included
in all copies or substantial portions of the Software.
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT
WARRANTY OF ANY KIND,
EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT
LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT.
IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT
HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY
CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER
IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT,
TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR
IN CONNECTION WITH THE
SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN
THE SOFTWARE.
fips181
URL: http://www.adel.nursat.kz/apg/
Copyright (c) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002
Adel I. Mirzazhanov. All rights reserved
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms,
with or without
modification, are permitted provided that the
following conditions
are met:
1.Redistributions of source code must retain the
above copyright notice,
this list of conditions and the following
disclaimer.
2.Redistributions in binary form must reproduce
the above copyright
notice, this list of conditions and the
following disclaimer in the
documentation and/or other materials
provided with the distribution.
3.The name of the author may not be used to
endorse or promote products
derived from this software without specific
prior written permission.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR
``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS
OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS
FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR ANY
DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL,
EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,
PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE
GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR
PROFITS; OR BUSINESS
INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON
ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY,
WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY,
OR TORT (INCLUDING
NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
OUT OF THE USE OF THIS
SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY
OF SUCH DAMAGE.
flac
URL: http://sourceforge.net/projects/flac/files/flac-
src/flac-1.2.1-src/flac-1.2.1.tar.gz/download
Copyright (C)
2000,2001,2002,2003,2004,2005,2006,2007 Josh
Coalson
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms,
with or without
modification, are permitted provided that the
following conditions
are met:
82
- Redistributions of source code must retain the
above copyright
notice, this list of conditions and the following
disclaimer.
- Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the
above copyright
notice, this list of conditions and the following
disclaimer in the
documentation and/or other materials provided with
the distribution.
- Neither the name of the Xiph.org Foundation nor
the names of its
contributors may be used to endorse or promote
products derived from
this software without specific prior written permission.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT
HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS
``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED
WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR
A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO
EVENT SHALL THE FOUNDATION OR
CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT,
INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL,
EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES
(INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,
PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR
SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR
PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER
CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF
LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING
NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
OUT OF THE USE OF THIS
SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY
OF SUCH DAMAGE.
harfbuzz-ng
URL: http://harfbuzz.org
HarfBuzz is licensed under the so-called "Old MIT"
license. Details follow.
For parts of HarfBuzz that are licensed under different
licenses see individual
files names COPYING in subdirectories where
applicable.
Copyright © 2010,2011,2012 Google, Inc.
Copyright © 2012 Mozilla Foundation
Copyright © 2011 Codethink Limited
Copyright © 2008,2010 Nokia Corporation and/or its
subsidiary(-ies)
Copyright © 2009 Keith Stribley
Copyright © 2009 Martin Hosken and SIL
International
Copyright © 2007 Chris Wilson
Copyright © 2006 Behdad Esfahbod
Copyright © 2005 David Turner
Copyright © 2004,2007,2008,2009,2010 Red Hat,
Inc.
Copyright © 1998-2004 David Turner and Werner
Lemberg
For full copyright notices consult the individual files in
the package.
Permission is hereby granted, without written
agreement and without
license or royalty fees, to use, copy, modify, and
distribute this
software and its documentation for any purpose,
provided that the
above copyright notice and the following two
paragraphs appear in
all copies of this software.
IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDER BE
LIABLE TO ANY PARTY FOR
DIRECT, INDIRECT, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL, OR
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES
ARISING OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE AND
ITS DOCUMENTATION, EVEN
IF THE COPYRIGHT HOLDER HAS BEEN ADVISED OF
THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
THE COPYRIGHT HOLDER SPECIFICALLY DISCLAIMS
ANY WARRANTIES, INCLUDING,
83
BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES
OF MERCHANTABILITY AND
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. THE
SOFTWARE PROVIDED HEREUNDER IS
ON AN "AS IS" BASIS, AND THE COPYRIGHT HOLDER
HAS NO OBLIGATION TO
PROVIDE MAINTENANCE, SUPPORT, UPDATES,
ENHANCEMENTS, OR MODIFICATIONS.
iccjpeg
URL: http://www.ijg.org
The authors make NO WARRANTY or representation,
either express or implied,
with respect to this software, its quality, accuracy,
merchantability, or
fitness for a particular purpose. This software is
provided "AS IS", and you,
its user, assume the entire risk as to its quality and
accuracy.
This software is copyright (C) 1991-1998, Thomas G.
Lane.
All Rights Reserved except as specified below.
Permission is hereby granted to use, copy, modify,
and distribute this
software (or portions thereof) for any purpose,
without fee, subject to these
conditions:
(1) If any part of the source code for this software is
distributed, then this
README file must be included, with this copyright
and no-warranty notice
unaltered; and any additions, deletions, or changes to
the original files
must be clearly indicated in accompanying
documentation.
(2) If only executable code is distributed, then the
accompanying
documentation must state that "this software is based
in part on the work of
the Independent JPEG Group".
(3) Permission for use of this software is granted only
if the user accepts
full responsibility for any undesirable consequences;
the authors accept
NO LIABILITY for damages of any kind.
These conditions apply to any software derived from
or based on the IJG code,
not just to the unmodified library. If you use our
work, you ought to
acknowledge us.
Permission is NOT granted for the use of any IJG
author's name or company name
in advertising or publicity relating to this software or
products derived from it.
This software may be referred to only as "the
Independent JPEG Group's
software".
We specifically permit and encourage the use of this
software as the basis of
commercial products, provided that all warranty or
liability claims are
assumed by the product vendor.
icu
URL: http://site.icu-project.org/
ICU License - ICU 1.8.1 and later
COPYRIGHT AND PERMISSION NOTICE
Copyright (c) 1995-2014 International Business
Machines Corporation and
others
All rights reserved.
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to
any person obtaining a
copy of this software and associated
documentation files (the
"Software"), to deal in the Software without
restriction, including
without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify,
merge, publish,
distribute, and/or sell copies of the Software, and
84
to permit persons to
whom the Software is furnished to do so, provided
that the above
copyright notice(s) and this permission notice
appear in all copies of
the Software and that both the above copyright
notice(s) and this
permission notice appear in supporting
documentation.
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT
WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS
OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO
THE WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT OF
THIRD PARTY RIGHTS. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
COPYRIGHT HOLDER OR HOLDERS
INCLUDED IN THIS NOTICE BE LIABLE FOR ANY
CLAIM, OR ANY SPECIAL INDIRECT
OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES, OR ANY
DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS
OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN AN
ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR
OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING OUT OF OR
IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR
PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
Except as contained in this notice, the name of a
copyright holder shall
not be used in advertising or otherwise to promote
the sale, use or
other dealings in this Software without prior
written authorization of
the copyright holder.
________________________________________
___________________________
All trademarks and registered trademarks
mentioned herein are the
property of their respective owners.
________________________________________
___________________________
Third-Party Software Licenses
This section contains third-party software notices
and/or additional
terms for licensed third-party software
components included within ICU
libraries.
1. Unicode Data Files and Software
COPYRIGHT AND PERMISSION NOTICE
Copyright © 1991-2014 Unicode, Inc. All rights
reserved.
Distributed under the Terms of Use in
http://www.unicode.org/copyright.html.
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any
person obtaining
a copy of the Unicode data files and any associated
documentation
(the "Data Files") or Unicode software and any
associated documentation
(the "Software") to deal in the Data Files or Software
without restriction, including without limitation the
rights to use,
copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, and/or sell
copies of
the Data Files or Software, and to permit persons to
whom the Data Files
or Software are furnished to do so, provided that
(a) this copyright and permission notice appear with
all copies
of the Data Files or Software,
(b) this copyright and permission notice appear in
associated
documentation, and
(c) there is clear notice in each modified Data File or
in the Software
as well as in the documentation associated with the
Data File(s) or
Software that the data or software has been modified.
THE DATA FILES AND SOFTWARE ARE PROVIDED
"AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF
ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT
NOT LIMITED TO THE
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR
A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND
85
NONINFRINGEMENT OF THIRD PARTY RIGHTS.
IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDER OR
HOLDERS INCLUDED IN THIS
NOTICE BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, OR ANY
SPECIAL INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL
DAMAGES, OR ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER
RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE,
DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF
CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER
TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING OUT OF OR IN
CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR
PERFORMANCE OF THE DATA FILES OR SOFTWARE.
Except as contained in this notice, the name of a
copyright holder
shall not be used in advertising or otherwise to
promote the sale,
use or other dealings in these Data Files or Software
without prior
written authorization of the copyright holder.
2. Chinese/Japanese Word Break Dictionary Data
(cjdict.txt)
# The Google Chrome software developed by
Google is licensed under the BSD li
ses, as set forth below.
#
# The BSD License
# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-
license.php
# Copyright (C) 2006-2008, Google Inc.
#
# All rights reserved.
#
# Redistribution and use in source and binary
forms, with or without modifi
cation, are permitted provided that the following
conditions are met:
#
# Redistributions of source code must retain
the above copyright notice, th
is list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
# Redistributions in binary form must
reproduce the above copyright notice,
this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
the documentation and/or
other materials provided with the distribution.
# Neither the name of Google Inc. nor the
names of its contributors may be
used to endorse or promote products derived from
this software without specific
prior written permission.
#
#
# THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE
COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS "AS I
S" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES,
INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPL
IED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLA
ECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY,
OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDIN
G, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF
SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE,
DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF L
IABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY,
OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR
OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE
USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED O
F THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
#
#
# The word list in cjdict.txt are generated by
combining three word lists l
isted
# below with further processing for
compound word breaking. The frequency i
s generated
# with an iterative training against Google
web corpora.
#
# * Libtabe (Chinese)
#
- https://sourceforge.net/project/?group_id=1519
# - Its license terms and conditions are
shown below.
#
# * IPADIC (Japanese)
#
- http://chasen.aist-
nara.ac.jp/chasen/distribution.html
86
# - Its license terms and conditions are
shown below.
#
# ---------COPYING.libtabe ----
BEGIN--------------------
#
# /*
# * Copyrighy (c) 1999 TaBE Project.
# * Copyright (c) 1999 Pai-Hsiang Hsiao.
# * All rights reserved.
# *
# * Redistribution and use in source and
binary forms, with or without
# * modification, are permitted provided
that the following conditions
# * are met:
# *
# * . Redistributions of source code must
retain the above copyright
# * notice, this list of conditions and the
following disclaimer.
# * . Redistributions in binary form must
reproduce the above copyright
# * notice, this list of conditions and the
following disclaimer in
# * the documentation and/or other
materials provided with the
# * distribution.
# * . Neither the name of the TaBE Project
nor the names of its
# * contributors may be used to endorse
or promote products derived
# * from this software without specific
prior written permission.
# *
# * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE
COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS
# * "AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED
WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
# * LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS
# * FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE
DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
# * REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE
LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT,
# * INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES
# * (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,
PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR
# * SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR
PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
# * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY
THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT,
# * STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING
NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE)
# * ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE
OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED
# * OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
DAMAGE.
# */
#
# /*
# * Copyright (c) 1999 Computer Systems
and Communication Lab,
# * Institute of
Information Science, Academia Sinica.
# * All rights reserved.
# *
# * Redistribution and use in source and
binary forms, with or without
# * modification, are permitted provided
that the following conditions
# * are met:
# *
# * . Redistributions of source code must
retain the above copyright
# * notice, this list of conditions and the
following disclaimer.
# * . Redistributions in binary form must
reproduce the above copyright
# * notice, this list of conditions and the
following disclaimer in
# * the documentation and/or other
materials provided with the
# * distribution.
# * . Neither the name of the Computer
Systems and Communication Lab
# * nor the names of its contributors may
be used to endorse or
# * promote products derived from this
software without specific
# * prior written permission.
# *
# * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE
87
COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS
# * "AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED
WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
# * LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS
# * FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE
DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
# * REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE
LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT,
# * INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES
# * (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,
PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR
# * SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR
PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
# * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY
THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT,
# * STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING
NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE)
# * ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE
OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED
# * OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
DAMAGE.
# */
#
# Copyright 1996 Chih-Hao Tsai @ Beckman
Institute, University of Illinois
# c-tsai4@uiuc.edu
http://casper.beckman.uiuc.edu/~c-tsai4
#
# ---------------COPYING.libtabe-----END
-----------------------------------
-
#
#
# ---------------COPYING.ipadic-----BEGI
N----------------------------------
--
#
# Copyright 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 Nara
Institute of Science
# and Technology. All Rights Reserved.
#
# Use, reproduction, and distribution of this
software is permitted.
# Any copy of this software, whether in its
original form or modified,
# must include both the above copyright
notice and the following
# paragraphs.
#
# Nara Institute of Science and Technology
(NAIST),
# the copyright holders, disclaims all
warranties with regard to this
# software, including all implied warranties of
merchantability and
# fitness, in no event shall NAIST be liable for
# any special, indirect or consequential
damages or any damages
# whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data
or profits, whether in an
# action of contract, negligence or other
tortuous action, arising out
# of or in connection with the use or
performance of this software.
#
# A large portion of the dictionary entries
# originate from ICOT Free Software. The
following conditions for ICOT
# Free Software applies to the current
dictionary as well.
#
# Each User may also freely distribute the
Program, whether in its
# original form or modified, to any third party
or parties, PROVIDED
# that the provisions of Section 3 ("NO
WARRANTY") will ALWAYS appear
# on, or be attached to, the Program, which is
distributed substantially
# in the same form as set out herein and that
such intended
# distribution, if actually made, will neither
violate or otherwise
# contravene any of the laws and regulations
of the countries having
# jurisdiction over the User or the intended
distribution itself.
#
# NO WARRANTY
#
# The program was produced on an
experimental basis in the course of the
88
# research and development conducted
during the project and is provided
# to users as so produced on an
experimental basis. Accordingly, the
# program is provided without any warranty
whatsoever, whether express,
# implied, statutory or otherwise. The term
"warranty" used herein
# includes, but is not limited to, any warranty
of the quality,
# performance, merchantability and fitness
for a particular purpose of
# the program and the nonexistence of any
infringement or violation of
# any right of any third party.
#
# Each user of the program will agree and
understand, and be deemed to
# have agreed and understood, that there is
no warranty whatsoever for
# the program and, accordingly, the entire
risk arising from or
# otherwise connected with the program is
assumed by the user.
#
# Therefore, neither ICOT, the copyright
holder, or any other
# organization that participated in or was
otherwise related to the
# development of the program and their
respective officials, directors,
# officers and other employees shall be held
liable for any and all
# damages, including, without limitation,
general, special, incidental
# and consequential damages, arising out of
or otherwise in connection
# with the use or inability to use the program
or any product, material
# or result produced or otherwise obtained
by using the program,
# regardless of whether they have been
advised of, or otherwise had
# knowledge of, the possibility of such
damages at any time during the
# project or thereafter. Each user will be
deemed to have agreed to the
# foregoing by his or her commencement of
use of the program. The term
# "use" as used herein includes, but is not
limited to, the use,
# modification, copying and distribution of
the program and the
# production of secondary products from the
program.
#
# In the case where the program, whether in
its original form or
# modified, was distributed or delivered to or
received by a user from
# any person, organization or entity other
than ICOT, unless it makes or
# grants independently of ICOT any specific
warranty to the user in
# writing, such person, organization or entity,
will also be exempted
# from and not be held liable to the user for
any such damages as noted
# above as far as the program is concerned.
#
# ---------------COPYING.ipadic-----END-
-----------------------------------
3. Lao Word Break Dictionary Data (laodict.txt)
Copyright (c) 2013 International Business Machines
Corporation and others. All Rights Reserved.
Project: http://code.google.com/p/lao-
dictionary/
Dictionary: http://lao-
dictionary.googlecode.com/git/Lao-Dictionary.txt
License: http://lao-dictionary.googlecode.com/g
it/Lao-Dictionary-LICEN
(copied below)
This file is derived from the above dictionary, with
slight modifications.
-------------------------------------------------
------------------------
Copyright (C) 2013 Brian Eugene Wilson, Robert
Martin Campbell.
All rights reserved.
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms,
with or without modification, are permitted provided
that the following conditions are met:
89
Redistributions of source code must retain the above
copyright no
tice, this list of conditions and the following
disclaimer. Redistributions
in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
notice, this list of cond
itions and the following disclaimer in the
documentation and/or other materi
als provided with the distribution.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT
HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS "AS IS" AND ANY
EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING,
BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES
OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A
PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO
EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDER OR
CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT,
INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES
(INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT
OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVIC
ES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS
INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED A
ND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN
CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT
(INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING
IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF
THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
-------------------------------------------------
------------------------
4. Burmese Word Break Dictionary Data
(burmesedict.txt)
Copyright (c) 2014 International Business Machines
Corporation and others. All Rights Reserved.
This list is part of a project hosted at:
github.com/kanyawtech/myanmar-karen-word-lists
-------------------------------------------------
------------------------
Copyright (c) 2013, LeRoy Benjamin Sharon
All rights reserved.
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms,
with or without modifi
cation, are permitted provided that the following
conditions are met:
Redistributions of source code must retain the above
copyright notice,
this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the
above copyright notic
e, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer
in the documentation an
d/or other materials provided with the distribution.
Neither the name Myanmar Karen Word Lists, nor
the names of its contributors may be used to
endorse or promote products derived from this
software without specific prior written permission.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT
HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS "AS I
S" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES,
INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMP
LIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE
DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT
HOLDER OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR
ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL,
EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DA
MAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,
PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVIC
ES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS
INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED A
ND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN
CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT
(INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING
IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF
THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
-------------------------------------------------
------------------------
5. Time Zone Database
ICU uses the public domain data and code derived
from Time Zone Database
for its time zone support. The ownership of the TZ
database is explained
in BCP 175: Procedure for Maintaining the Time
Zone Database section 7.
1 - Database Ownership
90
The TZ database itself is not an IETF Contribution
or an IETF
document. Rather it is a pre-existing and
regularly updated work
that is in the public domain, and is intended to
remain in the public
domain. Therefore, BCPs 78 [RFC5378] and 79
[RFC3979] do not apply
to the TZ Database or contributions that
individuals make to it.
Should any claims be made and substantiated
against the TZ Database,
the organization that is providing the IANA
Considerations defined in
this RFC, under the memorandum of
understanding with the IETF,
currently ICANN, may act in accordance with all
competent court
orders. No ownership claims will be made by
ICANN or the IETF Trust
on the database or the code. Any person making
a contribution to the
database or code waives all rights to future claims
in that
contribution or in the TZ Database.
google-jstemplate
URL: http://code.google.com/p/google-jstemplate/
Khronos header files
URL: http://www.khronos.org/registry
Copyright (c) 2007-2010 The Khronos Group Inc.
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any
person obtaining a
copy of this software and/or associated
documentation files (the
"Materials"), to deal in the Materials without
restriction, including
without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify,
merge, publish,
distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the
Materials, and to
permit persons to whom the Materials are furnished
to do so, subject to
the following conditions:
The above copyright notice and this permission
notice shall be included
in all copies or substantial portions of the Materials.
THE MATERIALS ARE PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT
WARRANTY OF ANY KIND,
EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT
LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT.
IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT
HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY
CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER
IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT,
TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR
IN CONNECTION WITH THE
MATERIALS OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN
THE MATERIALS.
SGI FREE SOFTWARE LICENSE B (Version 2.0, Sept.
18, 2008)
Copyright (C) 1992 Silicon Graphics, Inc. All Rights
Reserved.
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any
person obtaining a copy of
this software and associated documentation files (the
"Software"), to deal in
the Software without restriction, including without
limitation the rights to
use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute,
sublicense, and/or sell copies
of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the
Software is furnished to do
so, subject to the following conditions:
The above copyright notice including the dates of first
publication and either
this permission notice or a reference to
http://oss.sgi.com/projects/FreeB/
shall be included in all copies or substantial portions
of the Software.
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT
91
WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR
IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY,
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND
NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL SILICON
GRAPHICS, INC. BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM,
DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN
AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE,
ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION
WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER
DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE.
Except as contained in this notice, the name of Silicon
Graphics, Inc. shall
not be used in advertising or otherwise to promote
the sale, use or other
dealings in this Software without prior written
authorization from Silicon
Graphics, Inc.
LevelDB: A Fast Persistent Key-Value Store
URL: https://github.com/google/leveldb.git
Copyright (c) 2011 The LevelDB Authors. All rights
reserved.
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms,
with or without
modification, are permitted provided that the
following conditions are
met:
* Redistributions of source code must retain the
above copyright
notice, this list of conditions and the following
disclaimer.
* Redistributions in binary form must reproduce
the above
copyright notice, this list of conditions and the
following disclaimer
in the documentation and/or other materials provided
with the
* Neither the name of Google Inc. nor the names
of its
contributors may be used to endorse or promote
products derived from
this software without specific prior written permission.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT
HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS
"AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED
WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR
A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO
EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT
OWNER OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY
DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL,
SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT
LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE
GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE,
DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY
THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT,
STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT
(INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING
IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE
OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
The library to input, validate, and display
addresses.
URL: https://github.com/googlei18n/libaddressinput
libjingle
URL: http://www.webrtc.org
libjpeg
URL: http://www.ijg.org/
-------------------------------------------------
-------------------------------
The authors make NO WARRANTY or representation,
either express or implied,
with respect to this software, its quality, accuracy,
merchantability, or
fitness for a particular purpose. This software is
provided "AS IS", and you,
its user, assume the entire risk as to its quality and
accuracy.
92
This software is copyright (C) 1991-1998, Thomas G.
Lane.
All Rights Reserved except as specified below.
Permission is hereby granted to use, copy, modify,
and distribute this
software (or portions thereof) for any purpose,
without fee, subject to these
conditions:
(1) If any part of the source code for this software is
distributed, then this
README file must be included, with this copyright
and no-warranty notice
unaltered; and any additions, deletions, or changes to
the original files
must be clearly indicated in accompanying
documentation.
(2) If only executable code is distributed, then the
accompanying
documentation must state that "this software is based
in part on the work of
the Independent JPEG Group".
(3) Permission for use of this software is granted only
if the user accepts
full responsibility for any undesirable consequences;
the authors accept
NO LIABILITY for damages of any kind.
These conditions apply to any software derived from
or based on the IJG code,
not just to the unmodified library. If you use our
work, you ought to
acknowledge us.
Permission is NOT granted for the use of any IJG
author's name or company name
in advertising or publicity relating to this software or
products derived from it.
This software may be referred to only as "the
Independent JPEG Group's
software".
We specifically permit and encourage the use of this
software as the basis of
commercial products, provided that all warranty or
liability claims are
assumed by the product vendor.
sole proprietor of its copyright holder, Aladdin
Enterprises of Menlo Park, CA.
by the usual distribution terms of the Free Software
Foundation; principally,
that you must include source code if you redistribute
it. (See the file ansi2knr.c for
full details.)
However, since ansi2knr.c is not needed as part
of any program generated from the IJG code, this
does not limit you more than
the foregoing paragraphs do.
The Unix configuration script "configure" was
produced with GNU Autoconf.
It is copyright by the Free Software Foundation but is
freely distributable.
The same holds for its supporting scripts
(config.guess, config.sub,
ltconfig, ltmain.sh). Another support script, install-sh,
is copyright
by M.I.T. but is also freely distributable.
It appears that the arithmetic coding option of the
JPEG spec is covered by
patents owned by IBM, AT&T, and Mitsubishi. Hence
arithmetic coding cannot
legally be used without obtaining one or more
licenses. For this reason,
support for arithmetic coding has been removed from
the free JPEG software.
(Since arithmetic coding provides only a marginal gain
over the unpatented
Huffman mode, it is unlikely that very many
implementations will support it.)
So far as we are aware, there are no patent
restrictions on the remaining
The IJG distribution formerly included code to read
and write GIF files.
To avoid entanglement with the Unisys LZW patent,
GIF reading support has
been removed altogether, and the GIF writer has
been simplified to produce
"uncompressed GIFs". This technique does not use
the LZW algorithm; the
93
resulting GIF files are larger than usual, but are
readable by all standard
GIF decoders.
We are required to state that
"The Graphics Interchange Format(c) is the
Copyright property of
CompuServe Incorporated. GIF(sm) is a Service
Mark property of
CompuServe Incorporated."
-------------------------------------------------
-------------------------------
Public License.
libjpeg-turbo
URL: http://sourceforge.net/projects/libjpeg-turbo/
libjpeg-turbo is licensed under a non-restrictive, BSD-
style license
(see README.) The TurboJPEG/OSS wrapper (both
C and Java versions) and
associated test programs bear a similar license, which
is reproduced below:
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms,
with or without
modification, are permitted provided that the
following conditions are met:
- Redistributions of source code must retain the
above copyright notice,
this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
- Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the
above copyright notice,
this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
the documentation
and/or other materials provided with the
distribution.
- Neither the name of the libjpeg-turbo Project nor
the names of its
contributors may be used to endorse or promote
products derived from this
software without specific prior written permission.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT
HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS "AS IS",
AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES,
INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
COPYRIGHT HOLDERS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE
LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL,
SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT
LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF
SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE,
DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS
INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY
THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN
CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING
NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE)
ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS
SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
International Phone Number Library
URL:
http://libphonenumber.googlecode.com/svn/trunk/
Copyright (C) 2011 Google Inc.
Licensed under the Apache License, Version 2.0 (the
"License");
you may not use this file except in compliance with
the License.
You may obtain a copy of the License at
http://www.apache.org/licenses/LICENSE-2.0
Unless required by applicable law or agreed to in
writing, software
distributed under the License is distributed on an "AS
IS" BASIS,
WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF ANY
KIND, either express or implied.
See the License for the specific language governing
permissions and
limitations under the License.
94
libpng
URL: http://libpng.org/
This copy of the libpng notices is provided for your
convenience. In case of
any discrepancy between this copy and the notices in
the file png.h that is
included in the libpng distribution, the latter shall
prevail.
COPYRIGHT NOTICE, DISCLAIMER, and LICENSE:
If you modify libpng you may insert additional notices
immediately following
this sentence.
This code is released under the libpng license.
libpng versions 1.0.7, July 1, 2000, through 1.2.54,
November 12, 2015, are
Copyright (c) 2000-2002, 2004, 2006-2015 Glenn
Randers-Pehrson, are
derived from libpng-1.0.6, and are distributed
according to the same
disclaimer and license as libpng-1.0.6 with the
following individuals
added to the list of Contributing Authors:
Simon-Pierre Cadieux
Eric S. Raymond
Cosmin Truta
Gilles Vollant
and with the following additions to the disclaimer:
There is no warranty against interference with your
enjoyment of the
library or against infringement. There is no
warranty that our
efforts or the library will fulfill any of your
particular purposes
or needs. This library is provided with all faults,
and the entire
risk of satisfactory quality, performance, accuracy,
and effort is with
the user.
libpng versions 0.97, January 1998, through 1.0.6,
March 20, 2000, are
Copyright (c) 1998-2000 Glenn Randers-Pehrson, are
derived from
libpng-0.96, and are distributed according to the
same disclaimer and
license as libpng-0.96, with the following individuals
added to the list
of Contributing Authors:
Tom Lane
Glenn Randers-Pehrson
Willem van Schaik
libpng versions 0.89, June 1996, through 0.96, May
1997, are
Copyright (c) 1996-1997 Andreas Dilger, are derived
from libpng-0.88,
and are distributed according to the same disclaimer
and license as
libpng-0.88, with the following individuals added to
the list of
Contributing Authors:
John Bowler
Kevin Bracey
Sam Bushell
Magnus Holmgren
Greg Roelofs
Tom Tanner
libpng versions 0.5, May 1995, through 0.88, January
1996, are
Copyright (c) 1995-1996 Guy Eric Schalnat, Group 42,
Inc.
For the purposes of this copyright and license,
"Contributing Authors"
is defined as the following set of individuals:
Andreas Dilger
Dave Martindale
95
Guy Eric Schalnat
Paul Schmidt
Tim Wegner
The PNG Reference Library is supplied "AS IS". The
Contributing Authors
and Group 42, Inc. disclaim all warranties, expressed
or implied,
including, without limitation, the warranties of
merchantability and of
fitness for any purpose. The Contributing Authors
and Group 42, Inc.
assume no liability for direct, indirect, incidental,
special, exemplary,
or consequential damages, which may result from the
use of the PNG
Reference Library, even if advised of the possibility of
such damage.
Permission is hereby granted to use, copy, modify,
and distribute this
source code, or portions hereof, for any purpose,
without fee, subject
to the following restrictions:
1. The origin of this source code must not be
misrepresented.
2. Altered versions must be plainly marked as such
and must not
be misrepresented as being the original source.
3. This Copyright notice may not be removed or
altered from any
source or altered source distribution.
The Contributing Authors and Group 42, Inc.
specifically permit, without
fee, and encourage the use of this source code as a
component to
supporting the PNG file format in commercial
products. If you use this
source code in a product, acknowledgment is not
required but would be
END OF COPYRIGHT NOTICE, DISCLAIMER, and
LICENSE.
A "png_get_copyright" function is available, for
convenient use in "about"
boxes and the like:
printf("%s", png_get_copyright(NULL));
Also, the PNG logo (in PNG format, of course) is
supplied in the
files "pngbar.png.jpg" and "pngbar.jpg (88x31) and
"pngnow.png.jpg" (98x31).
Libpng is OSI Certified Open Source Software. OSI
Certified Open Source is
a certification mark of the Open Source Initiative. OSI
has not addressed
the additional disclaimers inserted at version 1.0.7.
Glenn Randers-Pehrson
glennrp at users.sourceforge.net
November 12, 2015
libsrtp
URL: https://github.com/cisco/libsrtp
/*
*
* Copyright (c) 2001-2006 Cisco Systems, Inc.
* All rights reserved.
*
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms,
with or without
* modification, are permitted provided that the
following conditions
* are met:
*
* Redistributions of source code must retain the
above copyright
* notice, this list of conditions and the following
disclaimer.
*
* Redistributions in binary form must reproduce
the above
* copyright notice, this list of conditions and the
following
96
* disclaimer in the documentation and/or other
materials provided
* with the distribution.
*
* Neither the name of the Cisco Systems, Inc. nor
the names of its
* contributors may be used to endorse or
promote products derived
* from this software without specific prior written
permission.
*
* THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE
COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS
* "AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED
WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
* LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS
* FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED.
IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
* COPYRIGHT HOLDERS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE
LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT,
* INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY,
OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES
* (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,
PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR
* SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR
BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
* HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF
LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT,
* STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING
NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE)
* ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS
SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED
* OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
*
*/
libusbx
URL: http://libusb.org
libvpx
URL: http://www.webmproject.org
Copyright (c) 2010, The WebM Project authors. All
rights reserved.
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms,
with or without
modification, are permitted provided that the
following conditions are
met:
* Redistributions of source code must retain the
above copyright
notice, this list of conditions and the following
disclaimer.
* Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the
above copyright
notice, this list of conditions and the following
disclaimer in
the documentation and/or other materials
provided with the
distribution.
* Neither the name of Google, nor the WebM
Project, nor the names
of its contributors may be used to endorse or
promote products
derived from this software without specific prior
written
permission.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT
HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS
"AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED
WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR
A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO
EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT
HOLDER OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY
DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL,
SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT
LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE
GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE,
DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY
THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT,
STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT
(INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING
IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE
OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
97
POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
WebP image encoder/decoder
URL: http://developers.google.com/speed/webp
Additional IP Rights Grant (Patents)
------------------------------------
"These implementations" means the copyrightable
works that implement the WebM
codecs distributed by Google as part of the WebM
Project.
Google hereby grants to you a perpetual, worldwide,
non-exclusive, no-charge,
royalty-free, irrevocable (except as stated in this
section) patent license to
make, have made, use, offer to sell, sell, import,
transfer, and otherwise
run, modify and propagate the contents of these
implementations of WebM, where
such license applies only to those patent claims, both
currently owned by
Google and acquired in the future, licensable by
Google that are necessarily
infringed by these implementations of WebM. This
grant does not include claims
that would be infringed only as a consequence of
further modification of these
or agree to the institution of patent litigation or any
other patent
enforcement activity against any entity (including a
cross-claim or
counterclaim in a lawsuit) alleging that any of these
implementations of WebM
or any code incorporated within any of these
implementations of WebM
constitute direct or contributory patent infringement,
or inducement of
patent infringement, then any patent rights granted to
you under this License
for these implementations of WebM shall terminate
as of the date such
litigation is filed.
libxml
URL: http://xmlsoft.org
Except where otherwise noted in the source code
(e.g. the files hash.c,
with different Copyright notices) all the files are:
Copyright (C) 1998-2012 Daniel Veillard. All Rights
Reserved.
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any
person obtaining a copy
of this software and associated documentation files
(the "Software"), to deal
in the Software without restriction, including without
limitation the rights
to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute,
sublicense, and/or sell
copies of the Software, and to permit persons to
whom the Software is fur-
nished to do so, subject to the following conditions:
The above copyright notice and this permission
notice shall be included in
all copies or substantial portions of the Software.
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT
WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR
IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FIT-
NESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND
NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR
ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER
LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT,
TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM,
OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE
OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN
THE SOFTWARE.
libxslt
URL: http://xmlsoft.org/XSLT
Licence for libxslt except libexslt
-------------------------------------------------
---------------------
Copyright (C) 2001-2002 Daniel Veillard. All Rights
98
Reserved.
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any
person obtaining a copy
of this software and associated documentation files
(the "Software"), to deal
in the Software without restriction, including without
limitation the rights
to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute,
sublicense, and/or sell
copies of the Software, and to permit persons to
whom the Software is fur-
nished to do so, subject to the following conditions:
The above copyright notice and this permission
notice shall be included in
all copies or substantial portions of the Software.
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT
WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR
IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FIT-
NESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND
NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
DANIEL VEILLARD BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM,
DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER
IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE,
ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CON-
NECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR
OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE.
Except as contained in this notice, the name of Daniel
Veillard shall not
be used in advertising or otherwise to promote the
sale, use or other deal-
ings in this Software without prior written
authorization from him.
-------------------------------------------------
---------------------
Licence for libexslt
-------------------------------------------------
---------------------
Copyright (C) 2001-2002 Thomas Broyer, Charlie
Bozeman and Daniel Veillard.
All Rights Reserved.
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any
person obtaining a copy
of this software and associated documentation files
(the "Software"), to deal
in the Software without restriction, including without
limitation the rights
to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute,
sublicense, and/or sell
copies of the Software, and to permit persons to
whom the Software is fur-
nished to do so, subject to the following conditions:
The above copyright notice and this permission
notice shall be included in
all copies or substantial portions of the Software.
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT
WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR
IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FIT-
NESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND
NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
AUTHORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR
OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER
IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE,
ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CON-
NECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR
OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE.
Except as contained in this notice, the name of the
authors shall not
be used in advertising or otherwise to promote the
sale, use or other deal-
ings in this Software without prior written
authorization from him.
-------------------------------------------------
---------------------
libyuv
URL: http://code.google.com/p/libyuv/
Copyright 2011 The LibYuv Project Authors. All rights
reserved.
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms,
with or without
99
modification, are permitted provided that the
following conditions are
met:
* Redistributions of source code must retain the
above copyright
notice, this list of conditions and the following
disclaimer.
* Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the
above copyright
notice, this list of conditions and the following
disclaimer in
the documentation and/or other materials
provided with the
distribution.
* Neither the name of Google nor the names of its
contributors may
be used to endorse or promote products derived
from this software
without specific prior written permission.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT
HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS
"AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED
WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR
A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO
EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT
HOLDER OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY
DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL,
SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT
LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE
GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE,
DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY
THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT,
STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT
(INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING
IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE
OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
linux-syscall-support
URL: http://code.google.com/p/linux-syscall-
support/
// Copyright 2015 The Chromium Authors. All rights
reserved.
//
// Redistribution and use in source and binary forms,
with or without
// modification, are permitted provided that the
following conditions are
// met:
//
// * Redistributions of source code must retain
the above copyright
// notice, this list of conditions and the following
disclaimer.
// * Redistributions in binary form must reproduce
the above
// copyright notice, this list of conditions and the
following disclaimer
// in the documentation and/or other materials
provided with the
// distribution.
// * Neither the name of Google Inc. nor the
names of its
// contributors may be used to endorse or promote
products derived from
// this software without specific prior written
permission.
//
// THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE
COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS
// "AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED
WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
// LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR
// A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO
EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT
// OWNER OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY
DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL,
// SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT
// LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE
GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE,
// DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS
INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY
// THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT,
STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT
100
// (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE)
ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE
// OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
LZ4 - Extremely fast compression
URL: https://code.google.com/p/lz4/
LZ4 Library
Copyright (c) 2011-2014, Yann Collet
All rights reserved.
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms,
with or without modification,
are permitted provided that the following conditions
are met:
* Redistributions of source code must retain the
above copyright notice, this
list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
* Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the
above copyright notice, this
list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
documentation and/or
other materials provided with the distribution.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT
HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS "AS IS" AND
ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES,
INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS
FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE
ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL,
EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES
(INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT
OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES;
LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS
INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON
ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN
CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT
(INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING
IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS
SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY
OF SUCH DAMAGE.
LZMA SDK
URL: http://www.7-zip.org/sdk.html
LZMA SDK is placed in the public domain.
mesa
URL: http://www.mesa3d.org/
The default Mesa license is as follows:
Copyright (C) 1999-2007 Brian Paul All Rights
Reserved.
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any
person obtaining a
copy of this software and associated documentation
files (the "Software"),
to deal in the Software without restriction, including
without limitation
the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish,
distribute, sublicense,
and/or sell copies of the Software, and to permit
persons to whom the
Software is furnished to do so, subject to the
following conditions:
The above copyright notice and this permission
notice shall be included
in all copies or substantial portions of the Software.
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT
WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS
OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY,
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND
NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL
BRIAN PAUL BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES
OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN
AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE,
ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN
CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE
OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE.
Some parts of Mesa are copyrighted under the GNU
LGPL. See the
Mesa/docs/COPYRIGHT file for details.
101
modp base64 decoder
URL: https://github.com/client9/stringencoders
* MODP_B64 - High performance base64
encoder/decoder
* Version 1.3 -- 17-Mar-2006
* http://modp.com/release/base64
*
* Copyright (c) 2005, 2006 Nick Galbreath -- nickg
[at] modp [dot] com
* All rights reserved.
*
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms,
with or without
* modification, are permitted provided that the
following conditions are
* met:
*
* Redistributions of source code must retain the
above copyright
* notice, this list of conditions and the following
disclaimer.
*
* Redistributions in binary form must reproduce
the above copyright
* notice, this list of conditions and the following
disclaimer in the
* documentation and/or other materials provided
with the distribution.
*
* Neither the name of the modp.com nor the
names of its
* contributors may be used to endorse or
promote products derived from
* this software without specific prior written
permission.
*
* THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE
COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS
* "AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED
WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
* LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR
* A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN
NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT
* OWNER OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY
DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL,
* SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT
* LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE
GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE,
* DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS
INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY
* THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT,
STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT
* (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE)
ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE
* OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
Mojo
URL: https://github.com/domokit/mojo
// Copyright 2014 The Chromium Authors. All rights
reserved.
//
// Redistribution and use in source and binary forms,
with or without
// modification, are permitted provided that the
following conditions are
// met:
//
// * Redistributions of source code must retain
the above copyright
// notice, this list of conditions and the following
disclaimer.
// * Redistributions in binary form must reproduce
the above
// copyright notice, this list of conditions and the
following disclaimer
// in the documentation and/or other materials
provided with the
// distribution.
// * Neither the name of Google Inc. nor the
names of its
// contributors may be used to endorse or promote
products derived from
// this software without specific prior written
permission.
//
// THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE
COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS
// "AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED
WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
102
// LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR
// A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO
EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT
// OWNER OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY
DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL,
// SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT
// LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE
GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE,
// DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS
INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY
// THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT,
STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT
// (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE)
ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE
// OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
mt19937ar
URL: http://www.math.sci.hiroshima-u.ac.jp/~m-
mat/MT/MT2002/emt19937ar.html
A C-program for MT19937, with initialization
improved 2002/1/26.
Coded by Takuji Nishimura and Makoto
Matsumoto.
Before using, initialize the state by using
init_genrand(seed)
or init_by_array(init_key, key_length).
Copyright (C) 1997 - 2002, Makoto Matsumoto
and Takuji Nishimura,
All rights
reserved.
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms,
with or without
modification, are permitted provided that the
following conditions
are met:
1. Redistributions of source code must retain the
above copyright
notice, this list of conditions and the
following disclaimer.
2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce
the above copyright
notice, this list of conditions and the
following disclaimer in the
documentation and/or other materials
provided with the distribution.
3. The names of its contributors may not be
used to endorse or promote
products derived from this software without
specific prior written
permission.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE
COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS
"AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED
WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR
A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN
NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT OWNER OR
CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT,
INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL,
EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES
(INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,
PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR
SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR
PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF
LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING
NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY
WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS
SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
Netscape Plugin Application Programming Interface
(NPAPI)
URL: http://mxr.mozilla.org/mozilla-
central/source/modules/plugin/base/public/
Version: MPL 1.1/GPL 2.0/LGPL 2.1
The contents of this file are subject to the Mozilla
Public License Version
the License. You may obtain a copy of the License at
103
http://www.mozilla.org/MPL/
Software distributed under the License is distributed
on an "AS IS" basis,
WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, either express
or implied. See the License
for the specific language governing rights and
limitations under the
The Original Code is mozilla.org code.
The Initial Developer of the Original Code is
Netscape Communications Corporation.
Portions created by the Initial Developer are
Copyright (C) 1998
the Initial Developer. All Rights Reserved.
Contributor(s):
Alternatively, the contents of this file may be used
under the terms of
either the GNU General Public License Version 2 or
later (the "GPL"), or
the GNU Lesser General Public License Version 2.1 or
later (the "LGPL"),
in which case the provisions of the GPL or the LGPL
are applicable instead
of those above. If you wish to allow use of your
version of this file only
under the terms of either the GPL or the LGPL, and
not to allow others to
use your version of this file under the terms of the
MPL, indicate your
decision by deleting the provisions above and replace
them with the notice
and other provisions required by the GPL or the LGPL.
If you do not delete
the provisions above, a recipient may use your
version of this file under
the terms of any one of the MPL, the GPL or the
LGPL.
OpenMAX DL
URL:
https://silver.arm.com/download/Software/Graphics/
OX000-BU-00010-r1p0-00bet0/OX000-BU-00010
-r1p0-00bet0.tgz
Use of this source code is governed by a BSD-style
license that can be
found in the LICENSE file in the root of the source
tree. All
contributing project authors may be found in the
AUTHORS file in the
root of the source tree.
The files were originally licensed by ARM Limited.
The following files:
* dl/api/omxtypes.h
* dl/sp/api/omxSP.h
are licensed by Khronos:
Copyright © 2005-2008 The Khronos Group Inc. All
Rights Reserved.
These materials are protected by copyright laws and
contain material
proprietary to the Khronos Group, Inc. You may use
these materials
for implementing Khronos specifications, without
altering or removing
any trademark, copyright or other notice from the
specification.
Khronos Group makes no, and expressly disclaims
any, representations
or warranties, express or implied, regarding these
materials, including,
without limitation, any implied warranties of
merchantability or fitness
for a particular purpose or non-infringement of any
intellectual property.
Khronos Group makes no, and expressly disclaims
any, warranties, express
or implied, regarding the correctness, accuracy,
completeness, timeliness,
and reliability of these materials.
Under no circumstances will the Khronos Group, or
any of its Promoters,
104
Contributors or Members or their respective partners,
officers, directors,
employees, agents or representatives be liable for
any damages, whether
direct, indirect, special or consequential damages for
lost revenues,
lost profits, or otherwise, arising from or in connection
with these
Khronos and OpenMAX are trademarks of the
Khronos Group Inc.
opus
URL: http://git.xiph.org/?p=opus.git
Copyright 2001-2011 Xiph.Org, Skype Limited, Octasic,
Jean-Marc Valin, Timothy
B. Terriberry,
CSIRO, Gregory Maxwell,
Mark Borgerding,
Erik de Castro Lopo
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms,
with or without
modification, are permitted provided that the
following conditions
are met:
- Redistributions of source code must retain the
above copyright
notice, this list of conditions and the following
disclaimer.
- Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the
above copyright
notice, this list of conditions and the following
disclaimer in the
documentation and/or other materials provided with
the distribution.
- Neither the name of Internet Society, IETF or IETF
Trust, nor the
names of specific contributors, may be used to
endorse or promote
products derived from this software without specific
prior written
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT
HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS
``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED
WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR
A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO
EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT OWNER
OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT,
INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL,
EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES
(INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,
PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR
SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR
PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER
CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF
LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING
NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
OUT OF THE USE OF THIS
SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY
OF SUCH DAMAGE.
Opus is subject to the royalty-free patent licenses
which are
specified at:
https://datatracker.ietf.org/ipr/1524/
Microsoft Corporation:
https://datatracker.ietf.org/ipr/1914/
Broadcom Corporation:
https://datatracker.ietf.org/ipr/1526/
OTS (OpenType Sanitizer)
URL: https://github.com/khaledhosny/ots.git
PLY (Python Lex-Yacc)
URL: http://www.dabeaz.com/ply/ply-3.4.tar.gz
PLY (Python Lex-Yacc)
Version 3.4
Protocol Buffers
URL: http://protobuf.googlecode.com/svn/trunk
Code generated by the Protocol Buffer compiler is
105
owned by the owner
of the input file used when generating it. This code is
not
standalone and requires a support library to be linked
with it. This
support library is itself covered by the above license.
Quick Color Management System
URL: https://github.com/jrmuizel/qcms/tree/v4
qcms
Copyright (C) 2009 Mozilla Corporation
Copyright (C) 1998-2007 Marti Maria
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any
person obtaining
a copy of this software and associated
documentation files (the "Software"),
to deal in the Software without restriction, including
without limitation
the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish,
distribute, sublicense,
and/or sell copies of the Software, and to permit
persons to whom the Software
is furnished to do so, subject to the following
conditions:
The above copyright notice and this permission
notice shall be included in
all copies or substantial portions of the Software.
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT
WARRANTY OF ANY KIND,
EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT
LIMITED TO
THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS
FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND
LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER
LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION
OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING
FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION
WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER
DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE.
re2 - an efficient, principled regular expression
library
URL: https://github.com/google/re2
sfntly
URL: https://github.com/googlei18n/sfntly
Skia
URL: https://skia.org/
-------------------------------------------------
-------------------------------
Some files under resources are under the following
license:
Unlimited Commercial Use
We try to make it clear that you may use all clipart
from Openclipart even for unlimited commercial use.
We believe that giving away our images is a great way
to share with the world our talents and that will come
back around in a better form.
May I Use Openclipart for?
We put together a small chart of as many possibilities
and questions we have heard from people asking
how they may use Openclipart. If you have an
additional question, please email
love@openclipart.org.
All Clipart are Released into the Public Domain.
Each artist at Openclipart releases all rights to the
images they share at Openclipart. The reason is so
that there is no friction in using and sharing images
authors make available at this website so that each
artist might also receive the same benefit in using
other artists clipart totally for any possible reason.
SMHasher
URL: http://code.google.com/p/smhasher/
Snappy: A fast compressor/decompressor
URL: http://google.github.io/snappy/
sqlite
URL: http://sqlite.org/
The author disclaims copyright to this source code.
In place of a legal notice, here is a blessing:
106
May you do good and not evil.
May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive
others.
May you share freely, never taking more than you
give.
tcmalloc
URL: http://gperftools.googlecode.com/
The USB ID Repository
URL: http://www.linux-usb.org/usb-ids.html
Copyright (c) 2012, Linux USB Project
All rights reserved.
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms,
with or without modification, are permitted provided
that the following conditions are met:
o Redistributions of source code must retain the
above copyright notice,
this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
o Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the
above copyright
notice, this list of conditions and the following
disclaimer in the
documentation and/or other materials provided
with the distribution.
o Neither the name of the Linux USB Project nor the
names of its
contributors may be used to endorse or promote
products derived from
this software without specific prior written
permission.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT
HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS "AS IS" AND ANY
EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING,
BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES
OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A
PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO
EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDER OR
CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT,
INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT
LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE
GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR
PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER
CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY,
WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR
TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE)
ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS
SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY
OF SUCH DAMAGE.
usrsctp
URL: http://github.com/sctplab/usrsctp
(Copied from the COPYRIGHT file of
https://code.google.com/p/sctp-
refimpl/source/browse/trunk/COPYRIGHT)
-------------------------------------------------
-------------------------------
Copyright (c) 2001, 2002 Cisco Systems, Inc.
Copyright (c) 2002-12 Randall R. Stewart
Copyright (c) 2002-12 Michael Tuexen
All rights reserved.
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms,
with or without
modification, are permitted provided that the
following conditions
are met:
notice, this list of conditions and the following
disclaimer.
notice, this list of conditions and the following
disclaimer in the
documentation and/or other materials provided
with the distribution.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR AND
CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES,
INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
AUTHOR OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL,
EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,
PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
107
OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR
BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF
LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR
OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF
ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
SUCH DAMAGE.
wayland
URL: http://wayland.freedesktop.org/
Copyright © 2008-2012 Kristian Høgsberg
Copyright © 2010-2012 Intel Corporation
Copyright © 2011 Benjamin Franzke
Copyright © 2012 Collabora, Ltd.
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any
person obtaining a
copy of this software and associated documentation
files (the "Software"),
to deal in the Software without restriction, including
without limitation
the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish,
distribute, sublicense,
and/or sell copies of the Software, and to permit
persons to whom the
Software is furnished to do so, subject to the
following conditions:
The above copyright notice and this permission
notice (including the next
paragraph) shall be included in all copies or
substantial portions of the
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT
WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR
IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY,
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND
NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL
THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE
FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER
LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT,
TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING
FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE
SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER
DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE.
---
The above is the version of the MIT "Expat" License
used by X.org:
http://cgit.freedesktop.org/xorg/xserver/tree/COPYIN
G
wayland-protocols
URL: http://wayland.freedesktop.org/
Copyright © 2008-2013 Kristian Høgsberg
Copyright © 2010-2013 Intel Corporation
Copyright © 2013 Rafael Antognolli
Copyright © 2013 Jasper St. Pierre
Copyright © 2014 Jonas Ådahl
Copyright © 2014 Jason Ekstrand
Copyright © 2014-2015 Collabora, Ltd.
Copyright © 2015 Red Hat Inc.
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any
person obtaining a
copy of this software and associated documentation
files (the "Software"),
to deal in the Software without restriction, including
without limitation
the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish,
distribute, sublicense,
and/or sell copies of the Software, and to permit
persons to whom the
Software is furnished to do so, subject to the
following conditions:
The above copyright notice and this permission
notice (including the next
paragraph) shall be included in all copies or
substantial portions of the
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT
WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR
IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE
108
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY,
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND
NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL
THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE
FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER
LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT,
TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING
FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE
SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER
DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE.
---
The above is the version of the MIT "Expat" License
used by X.org:
http://cgit.freedesktop.org/xorg/xserver/tree/COPYIN
G
Web Animations JS
URL: https://github.com/web-animations/web-
animations-js
WebRTC
URL: http://www.webrtc.org
Copyright (c) 2011, The WebRTC project authors. All
rights reserved.
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms,
with or without
modification, are permitted provided that the
following conditions are
met:
* Redistributions of source code must retain the
above copyright
notice, this list of conditions and the following
disclaimer.
* Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the
above copyright
notice, this list of conditions and the following
disclaimer in
the documentation and/or other materials
provided with the
distribution.
* Neither the name of Google nor the names of its
contributors may
be used to endorse or promote products derived
from this software
without specific prior written permission.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT
HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS
"AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED
WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR
A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO
EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT
HOLDER OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY
DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL,
SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT
LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE
GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE,
DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY
THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT,
STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT
(INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING
IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE
OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
x86inc
URL:
http://git.videolan.org/?p=x264.git;a=blob;f=common/
x86/x86inc.asm
;*********************************************************
********************
;* x86inc.asm
;*********************************************************
********************
;* Copyright (C) 2005-2011 x264 project
;*
;* Authors: Loren Merritt <lorenm@u.washington.edu>
;* Anton Mitrofanov
<BugMaster@narod.ru>
109
;* Jason Garrett-Glaser
<darkshikari@gmail.com>
;*
;* Permission to use, copy, modify, and/or distribute
this software for any
;* purpose with or without fee is hereby granted,
provided that the above
;* copyright notice and this permission notice appear
in all copies.
;*
;* THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS" AND THE
AUTHOR DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES
;* WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE INCLUDING
ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
;* MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS. IN NO EVENT
SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR
;* ANY SPECIAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, OR
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
;* WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE,
DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN AN
;* ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER
TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING OUT OF
;* OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR
PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
;*********************************************************
********************
; This is a header file for the x264ASM assembly
language, which uses
; NASM/YASM syntax combined with a large number
of macros to provide easy
; abstraction between different calling conventions
(x86_32, win64, linux64).
; It also has various other useful features to simplify
writing the kind of
; DSP functions that are most often used in x264.
; Unlike the rest of x264, this file is available under an
ISC license, as it
; has significant usefulness outside of x264 and we
want it to be available
; to the largest audience possible. Of course, if you
modify it for your own
; purposes to add a new feature, we strongly
encourage contributing a patch
; as this feature might be useful for others as well.
Send patches or ideas
; to x264-devel@videolan.org .
zlib
URL: http://zlib.net/
/* zlib.h -- interface of the 'zlib' general purpose
compression library
version 1.2.4, March 14th, 2010
Copyright (C) 1995-2010 Jean-loup Gailly and Mark
Adler
This software is provided 'as-is', without any
express or implied
warranty. In no event will the authors be held
liable for any damages
arising from the use of this software.
Permission is granted to anyone to use this
software for any purpose,
including commercial applications, and to alter it
and redistribute it
freely, subject to the following restrictions:
1. The origin of this software must not be
misrepresented; you must not
claim that you wrote the original software. If
you use this software
in a product, an acknowledgment in the product
documentation would be
appreciated but is not required.
2. Altered source versions must be plainly marked
as such, and must not be
misrepresented as being the original software.
3. This notice may not be removed or altered from
any source distribution.
Jean-loup Gailly
Mark Adler
*/
url_parse
URL: http://mxr.mozilla.org/comm-central/source/m
ozilla/netwerk/base/src/nsURLParsers.cpp
110
Copyright 2007, Google Inc.
All rights reserved.
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms,
with or without
modification, are permitted provided that the
following conditions are
met:
* Redistributions of source code must retain the
above copyright
notice, this list of conditions and the following
disclaimer.
* Redistributions in binary form must reproduce
the above
copyright notice, this list of conditions and the
following disclaimer
in the documentation and/or other materials provided
with the
* Neither the name of Google Inc. nor the names
of its
contributors may be used to endorse or promote
products derived from
this software without specific prior written permission.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT
HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS
"AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED
WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR
A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO
EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT
OWNER OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY
DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL,
SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT
LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE
GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE,
DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY
THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT,
STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT
(INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING
IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE
OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
-------------------------------------------------
------------------------------
The file url_parse.cc is based on nsURLParsers.cc
from Mozilla. This file is
licensed separately as follows:
The contents of this file are subject to the Mozilla
Public License Version
the License. You may obtain a copy of the License at
http://www.mozilla.org/MPL/
Software distributed under the License is distributed
on an "AS IS" basis,
WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, either express
or implied. See the License
for the specific language governing rights and
limitations under the
The Original Code is mozilla.org code.
The Initial Developer of the Original Code is
Netscape Communications Corporation.
Portions created by the Initial Developer are
Copyright (C) 1998
the Initial Developer. All Rights Reserved.
Contributor(s):
Darin Fisher (original author)
Alternatively, the contents of this file may be used
under the terms of
either the GNU General Public License Version 2 or
later (the "GPL"), or
the GNU Lesser General Public License Version 2.1 or
later (the "LGPL"),
in which case the provisions of the GPL or the LGPL
are applicable instead
of those above. If you wish to allow use of your
version of this file only
under the terms of either the GPL or the LGPL, and
not to allow others to
use your version of this file under the terms of the
MPL, indicate your
decision by deleting the provisions above and replace
111
them with the notice
and other provisions required by the GPL or the LGPL.
If you do not delete
the provisions above, a recipient may use your
version of this file under
the terms of any one of the MPL, the GPL or the
LGPL.
V8 JavaScript Engine
URL: http://code.google.com/p/v8
This license applies to all parts of V8 that are not
externally
maintained libraries. The externally maintained
libraries used by V8
are:
- PCRE test suite, located in
test/mjsunit/third_party/regexp-pcre/regexp-
pcre.js. This is based on the
test suite from PCRE-7.3, which is copyrighted by
the University
of Cambridge and Google, Inc. The copyright
notice and license
are embedded in regexp-pcre.js.
- Layout tests, located in
test/mjsunit/third_party/object-keys. These are
based on layout tests from webkit.org which are
copyrighted by
Apple Computer, Inc. and released under a
3-clause BSD license.
- Strongtalk assembler, the basis of the files
assembler-arm-inl.h,
assembler-arm.cc, assembler-arm.h, assembler-
ia32-inl.h,
assembler-ia32.cc, assembler-ia32.h, assembler-
x64-inl.h,
assembler-x64.cc, assembler-x64.h, assembler-
mips-inl.h,
assembler-mips.cc, assembler-mips.h,
assembler.cc and assembler.h.
This code is copyrighted by Sun Microsystems
Inc. and released
under a 3-clause BSD license.
- Valgrind client API header, located at
third_party/valgrind/valgrind.h
This is release under the BSD license.
These libraries have their own licenses; we
recommend you read them,
as their terms may differ from the terms below.
Further license information can be found in LICENSE
files located in
sub-directories.
Copyright 2014, the V8 project authors. All rights
reserved.
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms,
with or without
modification, are permitted provided that the
following conditions are
met:
* Redistributions of source code must retain the
above copyright
notice, this list of conditions and the following
disclaimer.
* Redistributions in binary form must reproduce
the above
copyright notice, this list of conditions and the
following
disclaimer in the documentation and/or other
materials provided
with the distribution.
* Neither the name of Google Inc. nor the names
of its
contributors may be used to endorse or
promote products derived
from this software without specific prior
written permission.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT
HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS
"AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED
WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR
A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO
EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT
OWNER OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY
112
DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL,
SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT
LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE
GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE,
DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY
THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT,
STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT
(INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING
IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE
OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
fdlibm
URL: http://www.netlib.org/fdlibm/
Copyright (C) 1993-2004 by Sun Microsystems, Inc.
All rights reserved.
Developed at SunSoft, a Sun Microsystems, Inc.
business.
Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this
software is freely granted, provided that this notice
is preserved.
Strongtalk
URL: http://www.strongtalk.org/
Copyright (c) 1994-2006 Sun Microsystems Inc.
All Rights Reserved.
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms,
with or without
modification, are permitted provided that the
following conditions are
met:
- Redistributions of source code must retain the
above copyright notice,
this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
- Redistribution in binary form must reproduce the
above copyright
notice, this list of conditions and the following
disclaimer in the
documentation and/or other materials provided with
the distribution.
- Neither the name of Sun Microsystems or the names
of contributors may
be used to endorse or promote products derived from
this software without
specific prior written permission.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT
HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS "AS
IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES,
INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,
THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL
THE COPYRIGHT OWNER OR
CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT,
INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL,
EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES
(INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,
PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR
SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR
PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER
CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF
LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING
NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
OUT OF THE USE OF THIS
SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY
OF SUCH DAMAGE.
Extra bundled binaries
name License
libcap
URL: https://sites.google.com/site/fullycapable/
Unless otherwise *explicitly* stated, the following text
describes the
licensed conditions under which the contents of this
libcap release
may be used and distributed:
-------------------------------------------------
------------------------
113
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms of
libcap, with
or without modification, are permitted provided that
the following
conditions are met:
notice, and this entire permission notice in its
entirety,
including the disclaimer of warranties.
copyright notices, this list of conditions, and the
following
disclaimer in the documentation and/or other
materials provided
with the distribution.
products derived from this software without their
specific prior
written permission.
ALTERNATIVELY, this product may be distributed
under the terms of the
GNU General Public License (v2.0 - see below), in
which case the
provisions of the GNU GPL are required INSTEAD OF
the above restrictions.
(This clause is necessary due to a potential conflict
between the GNU GPL and the restrictions contained
in a BSD-style
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED ``AS IS'' AND ANY
EXPRESS OR IMPLIED
WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,
THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A
PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED.
IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR(S) BE LIABLE FOR
ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT,
INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING,
BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF
SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS
OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS
INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND
ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN
CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR
TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE)
ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE
USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
-------------------------------------------------
------------------------
libnsspem
URL: https://git.fedorahosted.org/cgit/nss-pem.git
/* ***** BEGIN LICENSE BLOCK *****
* Version: MPL 1.1/GPL 2.0/LGPL 2.1
*
* The contents of this file are subject to the Mozilla
Public License Version
* 1.1 (the "License"); you may not use this file except
in compliance with
* the License. You may obtain a copy of the License
at
* http://www.mozilla.org/MPL/
*
* Software distributed under the License is
distributed on an "AS IS" basis,
* WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, either
express or implied. See the License
* for the specific language governing rights and
limitations under the
* License.
*
* The Original Code is the Netscape security libraries.
*
* The Initial Developer of the Original Code is
* Netscape Communications Corporation.
* Portions created by the Initial Developer are
Copyright (C) 1994-2000
* the Initial Developer. All Rights Reserved.
*
* Contributor(s):
* Rob Crittenden (rcritten@redhat.com)
*
* Alternatively, the contents of this file may be used
under the terms of
* either the GNU General Public License Version 2 or
later (the "GPL"), or
* the GNU Lesser General Public License Version 2.1
or later (the "LGPL"),
114
* in which case the provisions of the GPL or the
LGPL are applicable instead
* of those above. If you wish to allow use of your
version of this file only
* under the terms of either the GPL or the LGPL, and
not to allow others to
* use your version of this file under the terms of the
MPL, indicate your
* decision by deleting the provisions above and
replace them with the notice
* and other provisions required by the GPL or the
LGPL. If you do not delete
* the provisions above, a recipient may use your
version of this file under
* the terms of any one of the MPL, the GPL or the
LGPL.
* ***** END LICENSE BLOCK ***** */
Return to Documentation index.
© Opera TV AS 2015. Confidential information of
Opera TV.
BSD LICENSE
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms,
with or without modification, are permitted provided
that the following conditions are met:
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS
AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR
IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A
PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO
EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE
LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL,
SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,
PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR
SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR
BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND
ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN
CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING
NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF
ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
______________________________
MIT LICENSE
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any
person obtaining
a copy of this software and associated
documentation files (the
"Software"), to deal in the Software without
restriction, including
without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify,
merge, publish,
distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the
Software, and to
permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to
do so, subject to
the following conditions:
The above copyright notice and this permission
notice shall be included
in all copies or substantial portions of the Software.
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT
WARRANTY OF ANY KIND,
EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT
LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT.
IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT
HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY
CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER
IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT,
TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR
IN CONNECTION WITH THE
SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN
THE SOFTWARE.
_____________________________
This copy of the libpng notices is provided for your
convenience. In case of
any discrepancy between this copy and the notices in
the file png.h that is
included in the libpng distribution, the latter shall
prevail.
COPYRIGHT NOTICE, DISCLAIMER, and LICENSE:
If you modify libpng you may insert additional notices
immediately following
this sentence.
This code is released under the libpng license.
115
libpng versions 1.2.6, August 15, 2004, through 1.4.1,
February 25, 2010, are
Copyright (c) 2004, 2006-2007 Glenn Randers-
Pehrson, and are
distributed according to the same disclaimer and
license as libpng-1.2.5
with the following individual added to the list of
Contributing Authors
Cosmin Truta
libpng versions 1.0.7, July 1, 2000, through 1.2.5 -
October 3, 2002, are
Copyright (c) 2000-2002 Glenn Randers-Pehrson,
and are
distributed according to the same disclaimer and
license as libpng-1.0.6
with the following individuals added to the list of
Contributing Authors
Simon-Pierre Cadieux
Eric S. Raymond
Gilles Vollant
and with the following additions to the disclaimer:
There is no warranty against interference with your
enjoyment of the
library or against infringement. There is no
warranty that our
efforts or the library will fulfill any of your
particular purposes
or needs. This library is provided with all faults,
and the entire
risk of satisfactory quality, performance, accuracy,
and effort is with
the user.
libpng versions 0.97, January 1998, through 1.0.6,
March 20, 2000, are
Copyright (c) 1998, 1999 Glenn Randers-Pehrson, and
are
distributed according to the same disclaimer and
license as libpng-0.96,
with the following individuals added to the list of
Contributing Authors:
Tom Lane
Glenn Randers-Pehrson
Willem van Schaik
libpng versions 0.89, June 1996, through 0.96, May
1997, are
Copyright (c) 1996, 1997 Andreas Dilger
Distributed according to the same disclaimer and
license as libpng-0.88,
with the following individuals added to the list of
Contributing Authors:
John Bowler
Kevin Bracey
Sam Bushell
Magnus Holmgren
Greg Roelofs
Tom Tanner
libpng versions 0.5, May 1995, through 0.88, January
1996, are
Copyright (c) 1995, 1996 Guy Eric Schalnat, Group 42,
Inc.
For the purposes of this copyright and license,
"Contributing Authors"
is defined as the following set of individuals:
Andreas Dilger
Dave Martindale
Guy Eric Schalnat
Paul Schmidt
Tim Wegner
The PNG Reference Library is supplied "AS IS". The
Contributing Authors
and Group 42, Inc. disclaim all warranties, expressed
or implied,
including, without limitation, the warranties of
merchantability and of
fitness for any purpose. The Contributing Authors
and Group 42, Inc.
assume no liability for direct, indirect, incidental,
special, exemplary,
116
or consequential damages, which may result from the
use of the PNG
Reference Library, even if advised of the possibility of
such damage.
Permission is hereby granted to use, copy, modify,
and distribute this
source code, or portions hereof, for any purpose,
without fee, subject
to the following restrictions:
be misrepresented as being the original source.
source or altered source distribution.
The Contributing Authors and Group 42, Inc.
specifically permit, without
fee, and encourage the use of this source code as a
component to
supporting the PNG file format in commercial
products. If you use this
source code in a product, acknowledgment is not
required but would be
A "png_get_copyright" function is available, for
convenient use in "about"
boxes and the like:
printf("%s",png_get_copyright(NULL));
Also, the PNG logo (in PNG format, of course) is
supplied in the
files "pngbar.png.jpg" and "pngbar.jpg (88x31) and
"pngnow.png.jpg" (98x31).
Libpng is OSI Certified Open Source Software. OSI
Certified Open Source is a
certification mark of the Open Source Initiative.
Glenn Randers-Pehrson
glennrp at users.sourceforge.net
February 25, 2010
_____________________________
This software is based in part on the work of the
FreeType Team.
----------------------
The FreeType Project
LICENSE
----------------------------
2006-Jan-27
Copyright 1996-2002,
2006 by
David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and
Werner Lemberg
Introduction
============
The FreeType Project is distributed in several
archive packages;
some of them may contain, in addition to the
FreeType font engine,
various tools and contributions which rely on, or
relate to, the
FreeType Project.
This license applies to all files found in such
packages, and
which do not fall under their own explicit
license. The license
affects thus the FreeType font engine,
the test programs,
documentation and makefiles, at the very least.
This license was inspired by the BSD,
Artistic, and IJG
(Independent JPEG Group) licenses, which all
encourage inclusion
and use of free software in commercial and
freeware products
alike. As a consequence, its main points are that:
o We don't promise that this software works.
However, we will be
interested in any kind of bug reports. (`as is'
117
distribution)
o You can use this software for whatever you
want, in parts or
full form, without having to pay us. (`royalty-
free' usage)
o You may not pretend that you wrote this
software. If you use
it, or only parts of it, in a program, you
must acknowledge
somewhere in your documentation that
you have used the
FreeType code. (`credits')
We specifically permit and encourage the
inclusion of this
software, with or without modifications, in
commercial products.
We disclaim all warranties covering The
FreeType Project and
assume no liability related to The FreeType Project.
Finally, many people asked us for a
preferred form for a
credit/disclaimer to use in compliance with this
license. We thus
encourage you to use the following text:
"""
Portions of this software are copyright ɠ<year>
The FreeType
Project (www.freetype.org). All rights reserved.
"""
Please replace <year> with the value from the
FreeType version you
actually use.
Legal Terms
===========
--------------
Throughout this license, the terms `package',
`FreeType Project',
and `FreeType archive' refer to the set of
files originally
distributed by the authors (David Turner,
Robert Wilhelm, and
Werner Lemberg) as the `FreeType Project', be they
named as alpha,
beta or final release.
`You' refers to the licensee, or person using the
project, where
`using' is a generic term including compiling the
project's source
code as well as linking it to form a `program' or
`executable'.
This program is referred to as `a program
using the FreeType
engine'.
This license applies to all files distributed in
the original
FreeType Project, including all source
code, binaries and
documentation, unless otherwise stated in
the file in its
original, unmodified form as distributed in the
original archive.
If you are unsure whether or not a particular file
is covered by
this license, you must contact us to verify this.
The FreeType Project is copyright (C) 1996-2000
by David Turner,
Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg. All rights
reserved except as
specified below.
--------------
THE FREETYPE PROJECT IS PROVIDED `AS IS'
WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY
KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED,
INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
PURPOSE. IN NO EVENT WILL ANY OF THE
AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS
BE LIABLE FOR ANY DAMAGES CAUSED BY THE
118
USE OR THE INABILITY TO
USE, OF THE FREETYPE PROJECT.
-----------------
This license grants a worldwide, royalty-
free, perpetual and
irrevocable right and license to use, execute,
perform, compile,
display, copy, create derivative works of,
distribute and
sublicense the FreeType Project (in both source
and object code
forms) and derivative works thereof for any
purpose; and to
authorize others to exercise some or all of the
rights granted
herein, subject to the following conditions:
o Redistribution of source code must retain
this license file
(`FTL.TXT') unaltered; any additions,
deletions or changes to
the original files must be clearly indicated in
accompanying
documentation. The copyright notices
of the unaltered,
original files must be preserved in all
copies of source
files.
o Redistribution in binary form must provide a
disclaimer that
states that the software is based in part of
the work of the
FreeType Team, in the distribution
documentation. We also
encourage you to put an URL to the FreeType
web page in your
documentation, though this isn't mandatory.
These conditions apply to any software derived
from or based on
the FreeType Project, not just the unmodified
files. If you use
our work, you must acknowledge us. However,
no fee need be paid
to us.
--------------
Neither the FreeType authors and contributors
nor you shall use
the name of the other for commercial, advertising,
or promotional
purposes without specific prior written permission.
We suggest, but do not require, that you use one
or more of the
following phrases to refer to this software in your
documentation
or advertising materials: `FreeType Project',
`FreeType Engine',
`FreeType library', or `FreeType Distribution'.
As you have not signed this license, you are
not required to
accept it. However, as the FreeType
Project is copyrighted
material, only this license, or another one
contracted with the
authors, grants you the right to use, distribute,
and modify it.
Therefore, by using, distributing, or modifying
the FreeType
Project, you indicate that you understand and
accept all the terms
of this license.
-----------
There are two mailing lists related to FreeType:
o freetype@nongnu.org
Discusses general use and applications of
FreeType, as well as
future and wanted additions to the library
and distribution.
If you are looking for support, start in this
list if you
haven't found anything to help you in the
documentation.
o freetype-devel@nongnu.org
119
Discusses bugs, as well as engine
internals, design issues,
specific licenses, porting, etc.
Our home page can be found at
http://www.freetype.org
--- end of FTL.TXT ---
_____________________________
MOZILLA PUBLIC
LICENSE
Version 1.1
---------------
1.0.1. "Commercial Use" means distribution or
otherwise making the
Covered Code available to a third party.
1.1. "Contributor" means each entity that creates
or contributes to
the creation of Modifications.
1.2. "Contributor Version" means the
combination of the Original
Code, prior Modifications used by a Contributor,
and the Modifications
made by that particular Contributor.
1.3. "Covered Code" means the Original Code or
Modifications or the
combination of the Original Code and
Modifications, in each case
including portions thereof.
1.4. "Electronic Distribution Mechanism" means
a mechanism generally
accepted in the software development
community for the electronic
transfer of data.
1.5. "Executable" means Covered Code in any
form other than Source
Code.
1.6. "Initial Developer" means the individual or
entity identified
as the Initial Developer in the Source Code
notice required by Exhibit
A.
1.7. "Larger Work" means a work which
combines Covered Code or
portions thereof with code not governed by the
terms of this License.
1.8. "License" means this document.
1.8.1. "Licensable" means having the right to
grant, to the maximum
extent possible, whether at the time of the
initial grant or
subsequently acquired, any and all of the rights
conveyed herein.
1.9. "Modifications" means any addition to or
deletion from the
substance or structure of either the Original
Code or any previous
Modifications. When Covered Code is released
as a series of files, a
Modification is:
A. Any addition to or deletion from the
contents of a file
containing Original Code or previous
Modifications.
B. Any new file that contains any part of
the Original Code or
previous Modifications.
1.10. "Original Code" means Source Code of
computer software code
which is described in the Source Code notice
required by Exhibit A as
Original Code, and which, at the time of its
release under this
License is not already Covered Code governed
120
by this License.
1.10.1. "Patent Claims" means any patent
claim(s), now owned or
hereafter acquired, including without
limitation, method, process,
and apparatus claims, in any patent Licensable
by grantor.
1.11. "Source Code" means the preferred form of
the Covered Code for
making modifications to it, including all modules
it contains, plus
any associated interface definition files, scripts
used to control
compilation and installation of an Executable,
or source code
differential comparisons against either the
Original Code or another
well known, available Covered Code of the
Contributor's choice. The
Source Code can be in a compressed or
archival form, provided the
appropriate decompression or de-archiving
software is widely available
for no charge.
1.12. "You" (or "Your") means an individual or a
legal entity
exercising rights under, and complying with all
of the terms of, this
License or a future version of this License
issued under Section 6.1.
For legal entities, "You" includes any entity
which controls, is
controlled by, or is under common control with
You. For purposes of
this definition, "control" means (a) the power,
direct or indirect,
to cause the direction or management of such
entity, whether by
contract or otherwise, or (b) ownership of more
than fifty percent
(50%) of the outstanding shares or beneficial
ownership of such
entity.
2.1. The Initial Developer Grant.
The Initial Developer hereby grants You a world-
wide, royalty-free,
non-exclusive license, subject to third party
intellectual property
claims:
(a) under intellectual property rights
(other than patent or
trademark) Licensable by Initial
Developer to use, reproduce,
modify, display, perform, sublicense and
distribute the Original
Code (or portions thereof) with or
without Modifications, and/or
as part of a Larger Work; and
(b) under Patents Claims infringed by the
making, using or
selling of Original Code, to make, have
made, use, practice,
sell, and offer for sale, and/or otherwise
dispose of the
Original Code (or portions thereof).
(c) the licenses granted in this Section
2.1(a) and (b) are
effective on the date Initial Developer
first distributes
Original Code under the terms of this
License.
(d) Notwithstanding Section 2.1(b) above,
no patent license is
granted: 1) for code that You delete from
the Original Code; 2)
separate from the Original Code; or 3)
for infringements caused
by: i) the modification of the Original
Code or ii) the
combination of the Original Code with
other software or devices.
2.2. Contributor Grant.
Subject to third party intellectual property
claims, each Contributor
hereby grants You a world-wide, royalty-free,
non-exclusive license
121
(a) under intellectual property rights
(other than patent or
trademark) Licensable by Contributor, to
use, reproduce, modify,
display, perform, sublicense and
distribute the Modifications
created by such Contributor (or portions
thereof) either on an
unmodified basis, with other
Modifications, as Covered Code
and/or as part of a Larger Work; and
(b) under Patent Claims infringed by the
making, using, or
selling of Modifications made by that
Contributor either alone
and/or in combination with its
Contributor Version (or portions
of such combination), to make, use, sell,
offer for sale, have
made, and/or otherwise dispose of: 1)
Modifications made by that
Contributor (or portions thereof); and 2)
the combination of
Modifications made by that Contributor
with its Contributor
Version (or portions of such
combination).
(c) the licenses granted in Sections 2.2(a)
and 2.2(b) are
effective on the date Contributor first
makes Commercial Use of
the Covered Code.
(d) Notwithstanding Section 2.2(b)
above, no patent license is
granted: 1) for any code that Contributor
has deleted from the
Contributor Version; 2) separate from
the Contributor Version;
3) for infringements caused by: i) third
party modifications of
Contributor Version or ii) the
combination of Modifications made
by that Contributor with other software
(except as part of the
Contributor Version) or other devices; or
4) under Patent Claims
infringed by Covered Code in the
absence of Modifications made by
that Contributor.
3.1. Application of License.
The Modifications which You create or to which
You contribute are
governed by the terms of this License, including
without limitation
Section 2.2. The Source Code version of
Covered Code may be
distributed only under the terms of this License
or a future version
of this License released under Section 6.1, and
You must include a
copy of this License with every copy of the
Source Code You
distribute. You may not offer or impose any
terms on any Source Code
version that alters or restricts the applicable
version of this
License or the recipients' rights hereunder.
However, You may include
an additional document offering the additional
rights described in
Section 3.5.
3.2. Availability of Source Code.
Any Modification which You create or to which
You contribute must be
made available in Source Code form under the
terms of this License
either on the same media as an Executable
version or via an accepted
Electronic Distribution Mechanism to anyone to
whom you made an
Executable version available; and if made
available via Electronic
Distribution Mechanism, must remain available
for at least twelve (12)
months after the date it initially became
available, or at least six
(6) months after a subsequent version of that
particular Modification
has been made available to such recipients.
You are responsible for
ensuring that the Source Code version remains
122
available even if the
Electronic Distribution Mechanism is maintained
by a third party.
3.3. Description of Modifications.
You must cause all Covered Code to which You
contribute to contain a
file documenting the changes You made to
create that Covered Code and
the date of any change. You must include a
prominent statement that
the Modification is derived, directly or indirectly,
from Original
Code provided by the Initial Developer and
including the name of the
Initial Developer in (a) the Source Code, and (b)
in any notice in an
Executable version or related documentation in
which You describe the
origin or ownership of the Covered Code.
3.4. Intellectual Property Matters
(a) Third Party Claims.
If Contributor has knowledge that a
license under a third party's
intellectual property rights is required to
exercise the rights
granted by such Contributor under
Sections 2.1 or 2.2,
Contributor must include a text file with
the Source Code
distribution titled "LEGAL" which
describes the claim and the
party making the claim in sufficient detail
that a recipient will
know whom to contact. If Contributor
obtains such knowledge after
the Modification is made available as
described in Section 3.2,
Contributor shall promptly modify the
LEGAL file in all copies
Contributor makes available thereafter
and shall take other steps
(such as notifying appropriate mailing
lists or newsgroups)
reasonably calculated to inform those
who received the Covered
Code that new knowledge has been
obtained.
(b) Contributor APIs.
If Contributor's Modifications include an
application programming
interface and Contributor has knowledge
of patent licenses which
are reasonably necessary to implement
that API, Contributor must
also include this information in the
LEGAL file.
(c) Representations.
Contributor represents that, except as
disclosed pursuant to
Section 3.4(a) above, Contributor
believes that Contributor's
Modifications are Contributor's original
creation(s) and/or
Contributor has sufficient rights to grant
the rights conveyed by
this License.
3.5. Required Notices.
You must duplicate the notice in Exhibit A in
each file of the Source
Code. If it is not possible to put such notice in
a particular Source
Code file due to its structure, then You must
include such notice in a
location (such as a relevant directory) where a
user would be likely
to look for such a notice. If You created one or
more Modification(s)
You may add your name as a Contributor to the
notice described in
Exhibit A. You must also duplicate this License
in any documentation
for the Source Code where You describe
recipients' rights or ownership
rights relating to Covered Code. You may
choose to offer, and to
charge a fee for, warranty, support, indemnity or
liability
obligations to one or more recipients of
Covered Code. However, You
may do so only on Your own behalf, and not on
behalf of the Initial
123
Developer or any Contributor. You must make it
absolutely clear than
any such warranty, support, indemnity or
liability obligation is
offered by You alone, and You hereby agree to
indemnify the Initial
Developer and every Contributor for any
liability incurred by the
Initial Developer or such Contributor as a result
of warranty,
support, indemnity or liability terms You offer.
3.6. Distribution of Executable Versions.
You may distribute Covered Code in Executable
form only if the
requirements of Section 3.1-3.5 have been met
for that Covered Code,
and if You include a notice stating that the
Source Code version of
the Covered Code is available under the terms
of this License,
including a description of how and where You
have fulfilled the
obligations of Section 3.2. The notice must be
conspicuously included
in any notice in an Executable version, related
documentation or
collateral in which You describe recipients'
rights relating to the
Covered Code. You may distribute the
Executable version of Covered
Code or ownership rights under a license of
Your choice, which may
contain terms different from this License,
provided that You are in
compliance with the terms of this License and
that the license for the
Executable version does not attempt to limit or
alter the recipient's
rights in the Source Code version from the rights
set forth in this
License. If You distribute the Executable version
under a different
license You must make it absolutely clear that
any terms which differ
from this License are offered by You alone, not
by the Initial
Developer or any Contributor. You hereby agree
to indemnify the
Initial Developer and every Contributor for any
liability incurred by
the Initial Developer or such Contributor as a
result of any such
terms You offer.
3.7. Larger Works.
You may create a Larger Work by combining
Covered Code with other code
not governed by the terms of this License and
distribute the Larger
Work as a single product. In such a case, You
must make sure the
requirements of this License are fulfilled for the
Covered Code.
If it is impossible for You to comply with any of
the terms of this
License with respect to some or all of the
Covered Code due to
statute, judicial order, or regulation then You
must: (a) comply with
the terms of this License to the maximum extent
possible; and (b)
describe the limitations and the code they
affect. Such description
must be included in the LEGAL file described in
Section 3.4 and must
be included with all distributions of the Source
Code. Except to the
extent prohibited by statute or regulation, such
description must be
sufficiently detailed for a recipient of ordinary
skill to be able to
understand it.
This License applies to code to which the Initial
Developer has
attached the notice in Exhibit A and to related
Covered Code.
6.1. New Versions.
Netscape Communications Corporation
("Netscape") may publish revised
and/or new versions of the License from time to
time. Each version
124
will be given a distinguishing version number.
6.2. Effect of New Versions.
Once Covered Code has been published under
a particular version of the
License, You may always continue to use it
under the terms of that
version. You may also choose to use such
Covered Code under the terms
of any subsequent version of the License
published by Netscape. No one
other than Netscape has the right to modify the
terms applicable to
Covered Code created under this License.
6.3. Derivative Works.
If You create or use a modified version of this
License (which you may
only do in order to apply it to code which is not
already Covered Code
governed by this License), You must (a) rename
Your license so that
the phrases "Mozilla", "MOZILLAPL", "MOZPL",
"Netscape",
"MPL", "NPL" or any confusingly similar phrase
do not appear in your
license (except to note that your license differs
from this License)
and (b) otherwise make it clear that Your
version of the license
contains terms which differ from the Mozilla
Public License and
Netscape Public License. (Filling in the name of
the Initial
Developer, Original Code or Contributor in the
notice described in
Exhibit A shall not of themselves be deemed to
be modifications of
this License.)
COVERED CODE IS PROVIDED UNDER THIS
LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER
EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING,
WITHOUT LIMITATION, WARRANTIES THAT
THE COVERED CODE IS FREE OF
DEFECTS, MERCHANTABLE, FIT FOR A
PARTICULAR PURPOSE OR NON-INFRINGING.
THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO THE QUALITY AND
PERFORMANCE OF THE COVERED CODE
IS WITH YOU. SHOULD ANY COVERED CODE
PROVE DEFECTIVE IN ANY RESPECT,
YOU (NOT THE INITIAL DEVELOPER OR ANY
OTHER CONTRIBUTOR) ASSUME THE
COST OF ANY NECESSARY SERVICING, REPAIR
OR CORRECTION. THIS DISCLAIMER
OF WARRANTY CONSTITUTES AN ESSENTIAL
PART OF THIS LICENSE. NO USE OF
ANY COVERED CODE IS AUTHORIZED
HEREUNDER EXCEPT UNDER THIS DISCLAIMER.
8.1. This License and the rights granted
hereunder will terminate
automatically if You fail to comply with terms
herein and fail to cure
such breach within 30 days of becoming aware
of the breach. All
sublicenses to the Covered Code which are
properly granted shall
survive any termination of this License.
Provisions which, by their
nature, must remain in effect beyond the
termination of this License
shall survive.
8.2. If You initiate litigation by asserting a
patent infringement
claim (excluding declatory judgment actions)
against Initial Developer
or a Contributor (the Initial Developer or
Contributor against whom
You file such action is referred to as
"Participant") alleging that:
(a) such Participant's Contributor Version
directly or indirectly
infringes any patent, then any and all rights
granted by such
Participant to You under Sections 2.1 and/or 2.2
of this License
shall, upon 60 days notice from Participant
terminate prospectively,
unless if within 60 days after receipt of notice
You either: (i)
agree in writing to pay Participant a mutually
agreeable reasonable
125
royalty for Your past and future use of
Modifications made by such
Participant, or (ii) withdraw Your litigation claim
with respect to
the Contributor Version against such
Participant. If within 60 days
of notice, a reasonable royalty and payment
arrangement are not
mutually agreed upon in writing by the parties
or the litigation claim
is not withdrawn, the rights granted by
Participant to You under
Sections 2.1 and/or 2.2 automatically terminate
at the expiration of
the 60 day notice period specified above.
(b) any software, hardware, or device, other
than such Participant's
Contributor Version, directly or indirectly
infringes any patent, then
any rights granted to You by such Participant
under Sections 2.1(b)
and 2.2(b) are revoked effective as of the date
You first made, used,
sold, distributed, or had made, Modifications
made by that
Participant.
8.3. If You assert a patent infringement claim
against Participant
alleging that such Participant's Contributor
Version directly or
indirectly infringes any patent where such claim
is resolved (such as
by license or settlement) prior to the initiation of
patent
infringement litigation, then the reasonable
value of the licenses
granted by such Participant under Sections 2.1
or 2.2 shall be taken
into account in determining the amount or
value of any payment or
license.
8.4. In the event of termination under Sections
8.1 or 8.2 above,
all end user license agreements (excluding
distributors and resellers)
which have been validly granted by You or any
distributor hereunder
prior to termination shall survive termination.
UNDER NO CIRCUMSTANCES AND UNDER NO
LEGAL THEORY, WHETHER TORT
(INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE), CONTRACT, OR
OTHERWISE, SHALL YOU, THE INITIAL
DEVELOPER, ANY OTHER CONTRIBUTOR, OR
ANY DISTRIBUTOR OF COVERED CODE,
OR ANY SUPPLIER OF ANY OF SUCH PARTIES,
BE LIABLE TO ANY PERSON FOR
ANY INDIRECT, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL, OR
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OF ANY
CHARACTER INCLUDING, WITHOUT
LIMITATION, DAMAGES FOR LOSS OF GOODWILL,
WORK STOPPAGE, COMPUTER FAILURE OR
MALFUNCTION, OR ANY AND ALL OTHER
COMMERCIAL DAMAGES OR LOSSES, EVEN IF
SUCH PARTY SHALL HAVE BEEN
INFORMED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
DAMAGES. THIS LIMITATION OF
LIABILITY SHALL NOT APPLY TO LIABILITY FOR
DEATH OR PERSONAL INJURY
RESULTING FROM SUCH PARTY'S
NEGLIGENCE TO THE EXTENT APPLICABLE LAW
PROHIBITS SUCH LIMITATION. SOME
JURISDICTIONS DO NOT ALLOW THE
EXCLUSION OR LIMITATION OF INCIDENTAL
OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES, SO
THIS EXCLUSION AND LIMITATION MAY NOT
APPLY TO YOU.
The Covered Code is a "commercial item," as
that term is defined in
48 C.F.R. 2.101 (Oct. 1995), consisting of
"commercial computer
software" and "commercial computer software
documentation," as such
terms are used in 48 C.F.R. 12.212 (Sept. 1995).
Consistent with 48
C.F.R. 12.212 and 48 C.F.R. 227.7202-1 through
227.7202-4 (June 1995),
all U.S. Government End Users acquire Covered
Code with only those
rights set forth herein.
This License represents the complete agreement
126
concerning subject
matter hereof. If any provision of this License is
held to be
unenforceable, such provision shall be
reformed only to the extent
necessary to make it enforceable. This License
shall be governed by
California law provisions (except to the extent
applicable law, if
any, provides otherwise), excluding its conflict-
of-law provisions.
With respect to disputes in which at least one
party is a citizen of,
or an entity chartered or registered to do
business in the United
States of America, any litigation relating to this
License shall be
subject to the jurisdiction of the Federal Courts
of the Northern
District of California, with venue lying in Santa
Clara County,
California, with the losing party responsible for
costs, including
without limitation, court costs and reasonable
attorneys' fees and
expenses. The application of the United Nations
Convention on
Contracts for the International Sale of Goods is
expressly excluded.
Any law or regulation which provides that the
language of a contract
shall be construed against the drafter shall not
apply to this
License.
As between Initial Developer and the
Contributors, each party is
responsible for claims and damages arising,
directly or indirectly,
out of its utilization of rights under this License
and You agree to
work with Initial Developer and Contributors to
distribute such
responsibility on an equitable basis. Nothing
herein is intended or
shall be deemed to constitute any admission of
liability.
Initial Developer may designate portions of the
Covered Code as
"Multiple-Licensed". "Multiple-Licensed"
means that the Initial
Developer permits you to utilize portions of the
Covered Code under
Your choice of the NPL or the alternative
licenses, if any, specified
by the Initial Developer in the file described in
Exhibit A.
EXHIBIT A -Mozilla Public License.
``The contents of this file are subject to the
Mozilla Public License
Version 1.1 (the "License"); you may not use this
file except in
compliance with the License. You may obtain a
copy of the License at
http://www.mozilla.org/MPL/
Software distributed under the License is
distributed on an "AS IS"
basis, WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND,
either express or implied. See the
License for the specific language governing
rights and limitations
under the License.
The Original Code is
______________________________________.
The Initial Developer of the Original Code is
________________________.
Portions created by ______________________
are Copyright (C) ______
_______________________. All Rights Reserved.
Contributor(s):
______________________________________.
Alternatively, the contents of this file may be
used under the terms
of the _____ license (the "[___] License"), in
which case the
provisions of [______] License are applicable
instead of those
127
above. If you wish to allow use of your version
of this file only
under the terms of the [____] License and not to
allow others to use
your version of this file under the MPL, indicate
your decision by
deleting the provisions above and replace
them with the notice and
other provisions required by the [___] License.
If you do not delete
the provisions above, a recipient may use your
version of this file
under either the MPL or the [___] License."
[NOTE: The text of this Exhibit A may differ
slightly from the text of
the notices in the Source Code files of the
Original Code. You should
use the text of this Exhibit A rather than the text
found in the
Original Code Source Code for Your
Modifications.]
128
13
Hilfe und Support
13.1
Fehlerbehebung
Einschalten und Fernbedienung
Der Fernseher lässt sich nicht einschalten.
• Trennen Sie das Stromkabel vom Netzanschluss.
Warten Sie eine Minute, und schließen Sie das
Stromkabel wieder an.
• Prüfen Sie, ob das Stromkabel sicher angeschlossen
ist.
Es ertönt ein Knackgeräusch beim Ein- oder
Ausschalten.
Beim Ein-/Ausschalten des Fernsehers oder beim
Schalten in den Standby-Modus hören Sie ein
Knackgeräusch im Gehäuse. Die Knackgeräusche sind
normal und entstehen, wenn sich der Fernseher beim
Aufwärmen oder Abkühlen dehnt. Dies hat keinen
Einfluss auf die Leistung des Geräts.
Der Fernseher reagiert nicht auf die Fernbedienung.
Der Fernseher benötigt eine gewisse Aufwärmzeit. In
dieser Zeit reagiert der Fernseher nicht auf die
Fernbedienung oder die frontseitigen
Bedienelemente. Das ist normal.
Wenn der Fernseher weiterhin nicht auf die
Fernbedienung reagiert, können Sie die Funktion der
Fernbedienung mit der Kamera eines Mobiltelefons
prüfen. Starten Sie die Kamerafunktion auf dem
Telefon, und zeigen Sie mit der Fernbedingung auf
das Kameraobjektiv. Wenn Sie eine beliebige Taste
auf der Fernbedienung drücken und über die Kamera
die Infrarot-LED aufleuchten sehen, funktioniert die
Fernbedienung, und der Fernseher muss überprüft
werden.
Wenn die LED nicht aufleuchtet, ist die
Fernbedienung möglicherweise defekt, oder die
Batterien sind leer.
Diese Prüfmethode für die Fernbedienung
funktioniert nicht bei Fernbedienungen, die kabellos
mit dem Fernseher gekoppelt sind.
Nach der Anzeige des Philips Startbildschirms
wechselt der Fernseher wieder in den Standby-
Modus.
Wenn sich der Fernseher im Standby-Modus
befindet, wird ein Philips Startbildschirm angezeigt,
und der Fernseher kehrt anschließend in den Standby-
Modus zurück. Das ist normal. Wenn der Fernseher
von der Stromversorgung getrennt und dann wieder
angeschlossen wird, wird beim nächsten Einschalten
des Geräts der Startbildschirm angezeigt. Wenn Sie
den Fernseher aus dem Standby-Modus einschalten
möchten, drücken Sie auf der Fernbedienung des
Fernsehers.
Die Standby-Anzeige blinkt dauerhaft.
Trennen Sie das Stromkabel vom Netzanschluss.
Warten Sie fünf Minuten, bevor Sie das Netzkabel
wieder anschließen. Kontaktieren Sie das Philips
Kundendienstzentrum, falls das Blinken erneut
auftritt.
Programme
Während der Installation wurden keine digitalen
Sender gefunden.
Lesen Sie die technischen Spezifikationen, um
sicherzustellen, dass Ihr Fernseher DVB-T oder DVB-
C in Ihrem Land unterstützt.
Vergewissern Sie sich, dass alle Kabel
ordnungsgemäß angeschlossen sind und dass das
korrekte Netzwerk ausgewählt wurde.
Installierte Sender werden in der Senderliste nicht
angezeigt.
Prüfen Sie, ob die korrekte Senderliste ausgewählt
wurde.
Bild
Kein Bild/verzerrtes Bild.
• Prüfen Sie, ob die Antenne korrekt mit dem
Fernseher verbunden ist.
• Prüfen Sie, ob das korrekte Gerät als Quelle für die
Anzeige ausgewählt wurde.
• Prüfen Sie, ob das externe Gerät bzw. die externe
Quelle korrekt angeschlossen ist.
Ton, aber kein Bild.
• Prüfen Sie, ob die Bildeinstellungen korrekt sind.
Schlechter Antennenempfang.
• Prüfen Sie, ob die Antenne korrekt mit dem
Fernseher verbunden ist.
• Lautsprecher, nicht geerdete Audiogeräte, Neonlicht,
hohe Gebäude und andere große Objekte können die
Empfangsqualität beeinträchtigen. Versuchen Sie, die
Bildqualität zu verbessern, indem Sie die Ausrichtung
der Antenne ändern oder den Abstand zu anderen
Geräten vergrößern.
• Falls die Empfangsqualität nur bei einem Sender
schlecht ist, nehmen Sie für diesen Sender eine
Feinabstimmung vor.
Schlechtes Bild über ein Gerät.
• Stellen Sie sicher, dass das Gerät ordnungsgemäß
angeschlossen ist.
• Prüfen Sie, ob die Bildeinstellungen korrekt sind.
Das Bild passt nicht auf den Bildschirm.
129
Wechseln Sie zu einem anderen Bildformat.
Die Position des Bilds ist nicht korrekt.
Die Bildsignale mancher Geräte passen u. U. nicht
richtig auf den Bildschirm. Überprüfen Sie den
Signalausgang des angeschlossenen Geräts.
Das Computerbild ist nicht stabil.
Prüfen Sie, ob Ihr PC die unterstützte Auflösung und
die Wiederholrate verwendet.
Ton
Kein Ton oder schlechte Tonqualität.
Falls kein Audiosignal erkannt wird, schaltet der
Fernseher den Ton automatisch aus.
• Prüfen Sie, ob die Toneinstellungen korrekt sind.
• Prüfen Sie, ob alle Kabel korrekt angeschlossen sind.
• Prüfen Sie, ob die Lautstärke stummgeschaltet oder
auf Null eingestellt ist.
• Prüfen Sie, ob der Audioausgang des Fernsehers mit
dem Audioeingang am Home Entertainment-System
verbunden ist.
Sie sollten Ton aus den HTS-Lautsprechern hören.
• Bei einigen Geräten müssen Sie die HDMI-
Audioausgabe möglicherweise manuell aktivieren.
Falls HDMI-Audio bereits aktiviert wurde, Sie aber
immer noch kein Audiosignal hören, versuchen Sie,
das digitale Audioformat des Geräts zu PCM (Pulse
Code Modulation) zu ändern. Anweisungen hierzu
finden Sie in der Dokumentation Ihres Geräts.
Anschlüsse
HDMI
- Bitte beachten Sie, dass es bei HDCP-Unterstützung
zu Verzögerungen bei der Anzeige von Inhalten von
HDMI-Geräten über den Fernseher kommen kann.
- Falls der Fernseher das HDMI-Gerät nicht erkennt
und kein Bild angezeigt wird, schalten Sie erst auf ein
anderes Gerät und anschließend wieder auf das
ursprüngliche Gerät um.
- Wenn Tonunterbrechungen auftreten, prüfen Sie, ob
die Ausgabeeinstellungen des HDMI-Geräts korrekt
sind.
- Wenn Sie einen HDMI-auf-DVI-Adapter oder ein
HDMI-auf-DVI-Kabel verwenden, muss ein
zusätzliches Audiokabel an AUDIO IN (nur
Minibuchse) angeschlossen sein.
EasyLink funktioniert nicht.
- Prüfen Sie, ob Ihre HDMI-Geräte HDMI-CEC-
kompatibel sind. Die EasyLink-Funktionen können
nur mit HDMI-CEC-kompatiblen Geräten verwendet
werden.
Es wird kein Lautstärkesymbol angezeigt.
- Wenn ein HDMI-CEC-Audiogerät angeschlossen ist,
ist dieses Verhalten normal.
Fotos, Videos und Musik von einem USB-Gerät
werden nicht angezeigt.
- Stellen Sie das USB-Speichergerät wie in der
Bedienungsanleitung beschrieben so ein, dass es mit
der Klasse der Massenspeicher kompatibel ist.
- Prüfen Sie, ob das USB-Speichergerät mit Ihrem
Fernseher kompatibel ist.
- Prüfen Sie, ob die Audio- und Bilddateiformate von
Ihrem Fernseher unterstützt werden.
USB-Dateien werden abgehackt wiedergegeben.
- Die Übertragungsleistung des USB-Speichergeräts
kann die Datenübertragungsrate zum Fernseher
einschränken, was eine schlechte Wiedergabequalität
zur Folge hat.
WiFi, Internet und Bluetooth
WiFi-Netzwerk wurde nicht gefunden oder ist
gestört
• Mikrowellenherde, DECT-Telefone oder andere
Geräte mit WiFi 802.11b/g/n/ac in der Nähe können
möglicherweise Störungen im WLAN-Netzwerk
verursachen.
• Stellen Sie sicher, dass Sie über die Firewalls im
Netzwerk Zugriff auf die kabellose Verbindung mit
dem Fernseher erlauben.
• Wenn das kabellose Netzwerk nicht ordnungsgemäß
funktioniert, testen Sie die kabelgebundene
Netzwerkinstallation.
Das Internet funktioniert nicht
• Prüfen Sie, falls die Verbindung zum Router
ordnungsgemäß funktioniert, die Verbindung des
Routers mit dem Internet.
Der PC und die Internetverbindung sind langsam
• Informieren Sie sich in der Bedienungsanleitung des
kabellosen Routers über die Reichweite in
Innenräumen, die Übertragungsrate und über die
anderen Faktoren zur Signalqualität.
• Sie benötigen für den Router eine
Hochgeschwindigkeitsverbindung (Breitband) zum
Internet.
DHCP
• Wenn keine Verbindung hergestellt werden kann,
überprüfen Sie die DHCP-Einstellung (Dynamic Host
Configuration Protocol) des Routers. DHCP sollte
aktiviert sein.
Bluetooth-Verbindung unterbrochen
• Orte mit hoher kabelloser Aktivität – Wohnungen
mit vielen kabellosen Routern – können die
kabellose Verbindung beeinträchtigen.
130
Netzwerk
WiFi-Netzwerk wurde nicht gefunden oder ist
gestört
• Mikrowellenherde, DECT-Telefone oder andere
Geräte mit WiFi 802.11b/g/n/ac in der Nähe können
möglicherweise Störungen im WLAN-Netzwerk
verursachen.
• Stellen Sie sicher, dass Sie über die Firewalls im
Netzwerk Zugriff auf die kabellose Verbindung mit
dem Fernseher erlauben.
• Wenn das kabellose Netzwerk nicht ordnungsgemäß
funktioniert, testen Sie die kabelgebundene
Netzwerkinstallation.
Das Internet funktioniert nicht
• Prüfen Sie, falls die Verbindung zum Router
ordnungsgemäß funktioniert, die Verbindung des
Routers mit dem Internet.
Der PC und die Internetverbindung sind langsam
• Informieren Sie sich in der Bedienungsanleitung des
kabellosen Routers über die Reichweite in
Innenräumen, die Übertragungsrate und über die
anderen Faktoren zur Signalqualität.
• Sie benötigen für den Router eine
Hochgeschwindigkeitsverbindung (Breitband) zum
Internet.
DHCP
• Wenn keine Verbindung hergestellt werden kann,
überprüfen Sie die DHCP-Einstellung (Dynamic Host
Configuration Protocol) des Routers. DHCP sollte
aktiviert sein.
13.2
Online-Hilfe
Um Probleme mit Ihrem Fernseher von Philips zu
lösen, können Sie sich an unseren Online-Support
wenden. Sie können Ihre Sprache auswählen und Ihre
Produkt-/Modellnummer eingeben.
Besuchen Sie www.philips.com/support
.
Auf der Support-Website finden Sie nicht nur
Antworten auf häufig gestellte Fragen (FAQs),
sondern auch die für Ihr Land relevante
Telefonnummer, über die Sie uns kontaktieren
können. In einigen Ländern können Sie sich mit
Fragen direkt per Chat an einen unserer Partner
wenden oder eine E-Mail schreiben.
Sie können neue Fernsehersoftware oder die
Anleitung herunterladen und diese auf dem
Computer lesen.
13.3
Support und Reparatur
Support und Reparaturen erhalten Sie unter der
Hotline des Service-Centers in Ihrem Land. Unsere
Servicetechniker kümmern sich um eine Reparatur,
falls erforderlich.
Die Telefonnummer finden Sie in der gedruckten
Dokumentation, die Sie gemeinsam mit dem
Fernseher erhalten haben.
Besuchen Sie alternativ unsere Website
unter www.philips.com/support
, und wählen Sie bei
Bedarf Ihr Land aus.
TV-Modellnummer und Seriennummer
Sie werden eventuell nach der
Modell-/Seriennummer Ihres Geräts gefragt. Diese
Nummern finden Sie auf dem Verpackungsetikett
oder auf dem Typenschild an der Unter- oder
Rückseite des Fernsehers.
Warnung
Versuchen Sie nicht, den Fernseher selbst zu
reparieren. Dies kann zu schweren Verletzungen,
irreparablen Schäden an Ihrem Fernseher oder dem
Verfall Ihrer Garantie führen.
131
14
Sicherheit und
Sorgfalt
14.1
Sicherheit
Wichtig!
Lesen Sie alle Sicherheitsanweisungen gründlich
durch, bevor Sie den Fernseher verwenden. Für
Schäden, die durch Nichtbeachtung der Anweisungen
verursacht wurden, haben Sie keinen
Garantieanspruch.
Keine Änderung dieses Geräts ohne Genehmigung
des Herstellers.
Risiko von Stromschlägen und
Brandgefahr
• Setzen Sie den Fernseher niemals Regen oder
Wasser aus. Platzieren Sie niemals Behälter mit
Flüssigkeiten, wie z. B. Vasen, in der Nähe des
Fernsehers.
Wenn der Fernseher außen oder innen mit Flüssigkeit
in Kontakt kommt, trennen Sie den Fernseher sofort
vom Stromnetz.
Kontaktieren Sie das Philips Service-Center, um den
Fernseher vor der erneuten Nutzung überprüfen zu
lassen.
• Setzen Sie den Fernseher, die Fernbedienung und
die Batterien niemals übermäßiger Hitze aus.
Platzieren Sie sie nie in der Nähe von brennenden
Kerzen, offenem Feuer oder anderen Wärmequellen.
Dies schließt auch direkte Sonneneinstrahlung ein.
• Führen Sie keine Gegenstände in die
Lüftungsschlitze oder andere Öffnungen des
Fernsehers ein.
• Stellen Sie niemals schwere Objekte auf das
Netzkabel.
• Stellen Sie sicher, dass der Netzstecker keinen
mechanischen Belastungen ausgesetzt wird. Lockere
Netzstecker können Funkenüberschlag oder Feuer
verursachen. Stellen Sie sicher, dass keine Zuglast auf
das Netzkabel ausgeübt wird, wenn der Bildschirm
gedreht wird.
• Um den Fernseher von der Stromversorgung zu
trennen, muss der Netzstecker aus der Steckdose
gezogen werden. Ziehen Sie dazu niemals am Kabel,
sondern immer am Stecker. Stellen Sie sicher, dass
der Zugang zum Netzstecker, Netzkabel und zur
Steckdose jederzeit frei ist.
Verletzungsgefahr oder
Beschädigungsgefahr für den
Fernseher
• Zum Heben und Tragen eines Fernsehers mit einem
Gewicht von über 25 kg sind zwei Personen
erforderlich.
• Wenn Sie den Fernseher auf einem Standfuß
aufstellen möchten, verwenden Sie nur den
mitgelieferten Standfuß, und befestigen Sie ihn fest
am Fernseher.
Stellen Sie den Fernseher auf eine flache, ebene
Fläche, die für das gesamte Gewicht des Fernsehers
und des Sockels geeignet ist.
• Stellen Sie bei einer Wandmontage sicher, dass die
Wandhalterung für das Gewicht des Fernsehers
geeignet ist. TP Vision übernimmt keine Haftung für
unsachgemäße Wandmontage oder daraus
resultierende Unfälle oder Verletzungen.
• Teile dieses Produkts sind aus Glas. Seien Sie
vorsichtig, um Verletzungen oder Beschädigungen zu
vermeiden.
Gefahr der Beschädigung des Fernsehers
Bevor Sie den Fernseher mit dem Stromnetz
verbinden, sollten Sie sicherstellen, dass die
Stromspannung dem auf der Rückseite des Geräts
angegebenen Wert entspricht. Schließen Sie den
Fernseher nicht an die Steckdose an, wenn die
Spannung einen anderen Wert aufweist.
Verletzungsgefahr für Kinder
Befolgen Sie diese Sicherheitshinweise, damit der
Fernseher nicht kippen kann und Kinder verletzen
könnte.
• Stellen Sie den Fernseher nie auf eine Fläche, die
mit einem Tuch oder einem anderen Material bedeckt
ist, das weggezogen werden kann.
• Stellen Sie sicher, dass kein Teil des Fernsehers über
die Ränder der Oberfläche hinausragt.
• Stellen Sie den Fernseher nie auf hohe Möbelstücke
(z. B. ein Bücherregal), ohne sowohl das Möbelstück
als auch den Fernseher an der Wand oder durch
geeignete Hilfsmittel zu sichern.
• Weisen Sie Kinder auf die Gefahren des Kletterns
auf Möbelstücke hin, um den Fernseher zu erreichen.
Gefahr des Verschluckens von Batterien!
Die Fernbedienung kann Knopfbatterien enthalten,
die von kleinen Kindern verschluckt werden könnten.
Bewahren Sie diese Batterien immer außerhalb der
Reichweite von Kindern auf!
132
Risiko der Überhitzung
Platzieren Sie den Fernseher nie in einem
geschlossenen Bereich. Der Fernseher benötigt einen
Lüftungsabstand von mindestens 10 cm um das
Gerät herum. Stellen Sie sicher, dass Vorhänge und
andere Gegenstände die Lüftungsschlitze des
Fernsehers nicht abdecken.
Gewitter
Trennen Sie den Fernseher vor Gewittern vom Netz-
und Antennenanschluss.
Berühren Sie den Fernseher, das Netzkabel oder das
Antennenkabel während eines Gewitters nicht.
Gefahr von Hörschäden
Vermeiden Sie den Einsatz von Ohrhörern oder
Kopfhörern bei hohen Lautstärken bzw. über einen
längeren Zeitraum.
Niedrige Temperaturen
Wenn der Fernseher bei Temperaturen unter 5 °C
transportiert wird, packen Sie den Fernseher aus, und
warten Sie, bis er Zimmertemperatur erreicht hat,
bevor Sie ihn mit dem Netzanschluss verbinden.
Luftfeuchtigkeit
In seltenen Fällen kann es je nach Temperatur und
Luftfeuchtigkeit zu einer geringfügigen Kondensation
an der Innenseite der Glasfront Ihres Fernsehers (bei
einigen Modellen) kommen. Um dies zu vermeiden,
setzen Sie den Fernseher weder direktem Sonnenlicht
noch Hitze oder extremer Feuchtigkeit aus. Tritt
dennoch eine Kondensation auf, geht sie von selbst
zurück, wenn Sie den Fernseher einige Stunden
verwenden.
Die Kondensationsfeuchtigkeit führt nicht zu
Beschädigungen oder Fehlfunktionen des Fernsehers.
14.2
Bildschirmpflege
• Berühren Sie den Bildschirm nicht mit
Gegenständen, drücken oder streifen Sie nicht mit
Gegenständen über den Bildschirm.
• Trennen Sie vor dem Reinigen den Netzstecker des
Fernsehers von der Steckdose.
• Reinigen Sie den Fernseher und den Rahmen
vorsichtig mit einem weichen feuchten Tuch.
Verwenden Sie keine Substanzen wie Alkohol,
Chemikalien oder Haushaltsreiniger.
• Um Verformungen und Farbausbleichungen zu
vermeiden, müssen Wassertropfen so rasch wie
möglich abgewischt werden.
• Vermeiden Sie nach Möglichkeit die Wiedergabe
von Standbildern. Standbilder sind Bilder, die über
einen längeren Zeitraum auf dem Bildschirm
verbleiben. Dazu gehören beispielsweise
Bildschirmmenüs, schwarze Balken und Zeitanzeigen.
Wenn Sie Standbilder wiedergeben möchten,
verringern Sie den Kontrast und die Helligkeit des
Bildschirms, um ihn vor Beschädigungen zu schützen.
14.3
Radiation Exposure
Statement
Dieses Gerät entspricht den CE-Grenzwerten für die
Strahlenbelastung in einer unkontrollierten
Umgebung. Dieses Gerät sollte mit einem
Mindestabstand von 20 cm zwischen der
Strahlungsquelle und Körpern installiert und
betrieben werden.
Die Frequenz, der Modus und die maximale
Sendeleistung in der EU sind im Folgenden
aufgeführt:
-
2400-2483.5MHz: < 20 dBm (EIRP)
-5150-5250MHz: < 23 dBm (EIRP)
-5250-5350MHz: < 23 dBm (EIRP)
-5470-5725MHz: < 27 dBm (EIRP)
-5725-5825MHz: < 13.98 dBm (EIRP)
133
15
Nutzungsbedingung
en
15.1
Nutzungsbedingungen –
Fernseher
2019 © TP Vision Europe B.V. Alle Rechte
vorbehalten.
Dieses Produkt wurde von TP Vision Europe B.V. oder
einem seiner Tochterunternehmen, in diesem
Dokument zusammen als TP Vision bezeichnet, auf
den Markt gebracht. TP Vision ist der Hersteller des
Produkts. Der Garantiegeber in Bezug auf den
Fernseher, dem diese Broschüre beilag, ist TP Vision.
Philips und das Philips Emblem sind eingetragene
Marken der Koninklijke Philips N.V.
Technische Daten können ohne vorherige
Ankündigung geändert werden. Die Marken sind
Eigentum von Koninklijke Philips N.V oder der
jeweiligen Eigentümer. TP Vision behält sich das
Recht vor, Produkte jederzeit ohne die Verpflichtung
zu ändern, frühere Lieferungen entsprechend
nachzubessern.
Das dem Fernseher beiliegende schriftliche Material
und die im Speicher des Fernsehers abgelegte bzw.
die von der Philips Website unter
www.philips.com/support heruntergeladene
Bedienungsanleitung sind für den beabsichtigen
Einsatz des Systems als korrekt anzusehen.
Die Informationen in dieser Anleitung werden für den
bestimmungsgemäßen Gebrauch des Systems als
angemessen erachtet. Wenn das Produkt oder seine
einzelnen Module oder Funktionen für andere
Zwecke verwendet werden als hier angegeben, ist
eine Bestätigung für deren Richtigkeit und Eignung
einzuholen. TP Vision gewährleistet, dass die
Informationen an sich keine US-Patente verletzen.
Alle anderen Gewährleistungen, gleich ob
ausdrücklich oder konkludent, sind ausgeschlossen.
TP Vision kann weder für Fehler im Inhalt dieses
Dokuments noch für Probleme, die aus dem Inhalt
dieses Dokuments resultieren, verantwortlich
gemacht werden. Fehler, die Philips gemeldet
werden, werden behoben und auf der Support-
Website von Philips so bald wie möglich
veröffentlicht.
Garantiebedingungen, Verletzungsgefahr,
Beschädigungsgefahr für den Fernseher oder
Erlöschen der Garantie!
Versuchen Sie keinesfalls, den Fernseher selbst zu
reparieren. Verwenden Sie Fernseher und Zubehör
ausschließlich wie vom Hersteller vorgesehen. Der
Warnhinweis auf der Rückseite des Fernsehers weist
auf das Risiko von elektrischen Schlägen hin. Öffnen
Sie niemals das Gehäuse des Fernsehers. Wenden Sie
sich bei Service- oder Reparaturarbeiten stets an den
Kundenservice von Philips. Die Telefonnummer
finden Sie in der gedruckten Dokumentation, die Sie
gemeinsam mit dem Fernseher erhalten
haben. Besuchen Sie alternativ unsere Website
unter www.philips.com/support, und wählen Sie bei
Bedarf Ihr Land aus. Jeder Betrieb, der in dieser
Anleitung ausdrücklich untersagt wird, und jegliche
Einstellungen oder Montageverfahren, die in dieser
Anleitung nicht empfohlen oder autorisiert werden,
führen zum Erlöschen der Garantie.
Pixeleigenschaften
Dieser Fernseher verfügt über eine hohe Anzahl von
Farbpixeln. Obwohl der Prozentsatz der
funktionsfähigen Pixel mindestens 99,999 % beträgt,
können auf dem Bildschirm permanent dunkle oder
helle Lichtpunkte (rot, grün oder blau) vorhanden
sein. Hierbei handelt es sich um eine bauartbedingte
Eigenschaft der Anzeige (innerhalb allgemeiner
Industriestandards) und nicht um eine Fehlfunktion.
CE-Konformität
TP Vision Europe B.V. erklärt hiermit, dass dieser
Fernseher den grundlegenden Anforderungen und
sonstigen relevanten Bestimmungen der
Richtlinien 2014/53/EU (RED), 2009/125/EC
(Energieverbrauchskennzeichnung) und 2011/65/EC
(RoHS) entspricht.
Konformität mit EMF
TP Vision produziert und vertreibt viele
Endkundenprodukte, die, wie jedes elektronische
Gerät im Allgemeinen, elektromagnetische Signale
aussenden und empfangen können. Eines der
grundsätzlichen Unternehmensprinzipien von TP
Vision ist es, für unsere Produkte alle notwendigen
Gesundheits- und Sicherheitsmaßnahmen zu
ergreifen, um allen anwendbaren rechtlichen
Anforderungen zu entsprechen und die zum
Zeitpunkt der Herstellung des Produkts anwendbaren
EMF-Normen in vollem Maße einzuhalten.
TP Vision verpflichtet sich, Produkte zu entwickeln,
herzustellen und zu vertreiben, die keine
gesundheitlichen Probleme hervorrufen. TP Vision
kann wissenschaftlichen Studien zufolge bestätigen,
dass ihre Produkte bei ordnungs- und
zweckgemäßem Gebrauch sicher sind. TP Vision
spielt eine aktive Rolle in der Entwicklung der
internationalen EMF- und Sicherheitsstandards,
sodass TP Vision auch weiterhin die neuesten
Entwicklungen der Standardisierung so früh wie
möglich in seine Produkte integrieren kann.
134
16
Copyright
16.1
MHL
MHL
MHL, Mobile High-Definition Link und das MHL-Logo
sind Marken oder eingetragene Marken der MHL, LLC.
16.2
HDMI
HDMI
Die Begriffe HDMI und HDMI High-Definition
Multimedia Interface und das HDMI-Logo sind
Marken oder eingetragene Marken von HDMI
Licensing LLC in den Vereinigten Staaten und in
anderen Ländern.
16.3
Dolby Audio
Dolby, Dolby Audio und das Doppel-D-Symbol sind
Marken von Dolby Laboratories. Hergestellt unter der
Lizenz von Dolby Laboratories. Vertrauliche
unveröffentlichte Werke. Copyright © 1992-2015
Dolby Laboratories. Alle Rechte vorbehalten.
16.4
DTS-HD Premium Sound™
DTS-HD Premium Sound™
Informationen zu DTS-Patenten finden Sie unter
http://patents.dts.com. Hergestellt unter der Lizenz
von DTS Licensing Limited. DTS, das Symbol sowie
DTS und das Symbol zusammen sind eingetragene
Marken, und DTS Premium Sound ist ein
Warenzeichen von DTS, Inc. © DTS, Inc. Alle Rechte
vorbehalten.
16.5
WiFi Alliance
WiFi
Wi-Fi®, das WiFi CERTIFIED-Logo und das WiFi-Logo
sind eingetragene Marken der Wi-Fi Alliance.
16.6
Kensington
Kensington
(falls zutreffend)
Kensington und Micro Saver sind in den USA
eingetragene Marken von ACCO World mit erteilten
Eintragungen und anhängigen Anmeldungen in
anderen Ländern weltweit.
135
16.7
Andere Marken
Alle anderen eingetragenen Marken und nicht
eingetragenen Marken sind Eigentum der jeweiligen
Inhaber.
136
17
Haftungsausschluss
bezüglich Diensten
und Software von
Drittanbietern
Von Dritten angebotene Dienste und
Softwareprodukte können ohne Ankündigung
geändert, ausgesetzt oder beendet werden. TP Vision
trägt in solchen Situationen keinerlei Verantwortung.
137
Index
A
Android-Einstellungen 35
Audiosprache 37
Audiosprache, alternativ 37
Audiosprache, bevorzugt 37
Aufstellungsort 4
Ü
Überprüfen des Energieverbrauchs 31
B
Betrachtungsabstand 4
Bild, Bildformat 31
Bildeinstellung 29
Bildschirmpflege 133
Blu-ray Disc-Player, Verbinden 17
C
CAM, Conditional Access Module 15
CI+ 15
CI-Steckplatz 15
Computer, Anschließen 18
E
Einschalten 8
Einstellungen der Untertitelsprache, alternativ 36
Einstellungen der Untertitelsprache, bevorzugt 36
Energiespareinstellungen 31
Entsorgung des Fernsehers und der Batterien 9
EU-Umweltzeichen 9
F
Farbe, Farbspektrum 30
Fehlerbehebung 129
Fernsehen 36
Fotos, Videos und Musik 19
H
Hörbehindert 32
HDMI MHL 14
Home 24
I
Internetspeicher, Löschen 34
K
Kabelgebundenes Netzwerk 34
Kindersicherung 32
Kontaktaufnahme zu Philips 131
Kontrast, Dynamic Contrast 30
Kontrast, Kontrastmodus 30
M
Medien 19
Mediendateien, Von einem USB-Laufwerk 19
MPEG-Artefaktunterdrückung 30
N
Netzkabel 5
Netzwerk, Einstellungen 34
Netzwerk, Kabelgebunden 34
Netzwerk, Verbinden 33
Netzwerk, WPS mit PIN-Code 33
Netzwerkinstallation 33
Netzwerkname des Fernsehers 34
Nutzungsbedingungen 134
Nutzungsende 9
O
Online-Support 131
Open-Source-Software 41
P
Probleme, Bild 129
Probleme, Fernbedienung 129
Probleme, HDMI-Verbindung 130
Probleme, Sender 129
Probleme, Ton 130
Probleme, USB-Verbindung 130
Probleme, Verbindung, Internet 131
Probleme, Verbindung, WiFi 131
Produktdatenblatt 9
R
Radiosender 36
Reparieren 131
S
Schärfe, MPEG-Artefaktunterdrückung 30
Seh- und Hörhilfen 32
Sehbehindert 32
Sender 36
Sender, Antenneninstallation 37
Sender, Einstellung 37
Sender, Neu installieren 37
Sender, Optionen 36
Sender, Wechseln zu einem Sender 36
Senderliste 36
Senderliste, Öffnen 36
Senderliste, Informationen 36
Sendung themenabhängig sperren 32
Service-Center 131
Sicherheitshinweise 132
Smart Card, CAM 15
Software, Aktualisierung 40
Spielkonsole, Anschließen 17
Standby 8
Support, Online 131
T
Ton, Einstellungen 31
U
Untertitel 36
Untertitelsprache 36
V
Verbindungsleitfaden 13
W
WiFi 33
WLAN-Netzwerk 33
138
Powered by TCPDF (www.tcpdf.org)
139
134


Need help? Post your question in this forum.

Forumrules


Report abuse

Libble takes abuse of its services very seriously. We're committed to dealing with such abuse according to the laws in your country of residence. When you submit a report, we'll investigate it and take the appropriate action. We'll get back to you only if we require additional details or have more information to share.

Product:

For example, Anti-Semitic content, racist content, or material that could result in a violent physical act.

For example, a credit card number, a personal identification number, or an unlisted home address. Note that email addresses and full names are not considered private information.

Forumrules

To achieve meaningful questions, we apply the following rules:

Register

Register getting emails for Philips 50HFL5014 at:


You will receive an email to register for one or both of the options.


Get your user manual by e-mail

Enter your email address to receive the manual of Philips 50HFL5014 in the language / languages: German as an attachment in your email.

The manual is 2,51 mb in size.

 

You will receive the manual in your email within minutes. If you have not received an email, then probably have entered the wrong email address or your mailbox is too full. In addition, it may be that your ISP may have a maximum size for emails to receive.

Others manual(s) of Philips 50HFL5014

Philips 50HFL5014 User Manual - German - 138 pages

Philips 50HFL5014 User Manual - Dutch - 139 pages


The manual is sent by email. Check your email

If you have not received an email with the manual within fifteen minutes, it may be that you have a entered a wrong email address or that your ISP has set a maximum size to receive email that is smaller than the size of the manual.

The email address you have provided is not correct.

Please check the email address and correct it.

Your question is posted on this page

Would you like to receive an email when new answers and questions are posted? Please enter your email address.



Info